blob: d8f4de7f58a42bb1fc1f57905d45cdbc3fbdc01d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau37242fa2010-08-28 19:21:00 +02007 2010/08/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -d
421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
438 - nbproc
439 - pidfile
440 - uid
441 - ulimit-n
442 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200443 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200444 - node
445 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100446 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100447
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 * Performance tuning
449 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100450 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 - noepoll
452 - nokqueue
453 - nopoll
454 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100455 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200456 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200457 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200458 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100459 - tune.maxaccept
460 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200461 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100462 - tune.rcvbuf.client
463 - tune.rcvbuf.server
464 - tune.sndbuf.client
465 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Debugging
468 - debug
469 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200470
471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004723.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200473------------------------------------
474
475chroot <jail dir>
476 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
477 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
478 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
479 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
480 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
481 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100482
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200483daemon
484 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
485 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
486 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
487
488gid <number>
489 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
490 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
491 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
492 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100493
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200494group <group name>
495 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
496 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100497
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200498log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
500 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100501 configured with "log global".
502
503 <address> can be one of:
504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100505 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100506 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
507 port).
508
509 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
510 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
511 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
512 writeable).
513
514 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515
516 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
517 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
518 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
519
520 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200521 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
522 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
523 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
524 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
525 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
526 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527
528 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
529
530nbproc <number>
531 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
532 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
533 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
534 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
535 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
536
537pidfile <pidfile>
538 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
539 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
540 starting the process. See also "daemon".
541
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200542stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200543 [level <level>]
544
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200545 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
546 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100547 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200548 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
549
550 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
551 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
552 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
553 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
554 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
555
556 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
557 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
558 counters).
559
560 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
561 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100562
563 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
564 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
565 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
566 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
567 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
568 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
569 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200570
571stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
572 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
573 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100574 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200575
576stats maxconn <connections>
577 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
578 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
579
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580uid <number>
581 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
582 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
583 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
584 one. See also "gid" and "user".
585
586ulimit-n <number>
587 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
588 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
589 option.
590
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100591unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
592 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
593
594 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
595 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
596 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
597 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
598 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
599 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
600 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
601 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
602 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
603 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605user <user name>
606 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
607 See also "uid" and "group".
608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200609node <name>
610 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
611
612 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
613 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
614 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
615 traffic.
616
617description <text>
618 Add a text that describes the instance.
619
620 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
621 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
622 "<" and ">" characters.
623
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626-----------------------
627
628maxconn <number>
629 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
630 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
631 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
632 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
633
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100634maxpipes <number>
635 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
636 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
637 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
638 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
639 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
640 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642noepoll
643 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
644 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
645 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
646
647nokqueue
648 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
649 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
650 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
651
652nopoll
653 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
654 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100655 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
657 "nokqueue".
658
659nosepoll
660 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
661 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
662 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
663
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100664nosplice
665 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
666 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
667 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100668 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100669 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
670 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
671 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
672 "option splice-response".
673
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200674spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
675 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
676 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
677 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
678 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
679 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
680
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200681tune.bufsize <number>
682 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
683 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
684 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
685 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
686 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
687 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
688 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
689 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
690
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200691tune.chksize <number>
692 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
693 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
694 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
695 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
696 checks whenever possible.
697
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100698tune.maxaccept <number>
699 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
700 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
701 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100702 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100703 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
704 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100705 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100706 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
707
708tune.maxpollevents <number>
709 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
710 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
711 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
712 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
713 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
714
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200715tune.maxrewrite <number>
716 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
717 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
718 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
719 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
720 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
721 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
722 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
723 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
724 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
725 bufsize.
726
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100727tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
728tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
729 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
730 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
731 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
732 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
733 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
734 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
735 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
736
737tune.sndbuf.client <number>
738tune.sndbuf.server <number>
739 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
740 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
741 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
742 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
743 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
744 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
745 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
746 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
747 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
748 notifying haproxy again.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.3. Debugging
752--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
754debug
755 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
756 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
757 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
758 system startup.
759
760quiet
761 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
762 line argument "-q".
763
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007653.4. Userlists
766--------------
767It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
768http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
769it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
770
771userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100772 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100773 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
774
775group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100776 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100777 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
778 proceeded by "users" keyword.
779
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100780user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
781 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100782 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
783 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100784 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
785 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100786 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
787 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
788
789
790 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100791 userlist L1
792 group G1 users tiger,scott
793 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100794
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100795 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
796 user scott insecure-password elgato
797 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100798
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100799 userlist L2
800 group G1
801 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100802
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100803 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
804 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
805 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100806
807 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200809
8103.5. Peers
811--------------
812It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
813haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
814pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
815identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
816or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
817Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
818known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
819the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
820process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
821during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
822tables.
823
824peers <peersect>
825 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
826 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
827
828peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
829 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
830 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
831 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
832 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
833 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
834 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
835
836 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
837 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
838
839 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
840 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
841 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
842 across all peers.
843
844Example:
845 peers mypeers
846 peers haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
847 peers haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
848 peers haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
849
850 backend mybackend
851 mode tcp
852 balance roundrobin
853 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
854 stick on src
855
856 server srv1 192.168.30:80
857 server srv2 192.168.31:80
858
859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008604. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200861----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200863Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
864 - defaults <name>
865 - frontend <name>
866 - backend <name>
867 - listen <name>
868
869A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
870its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
871section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100872section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200873
874A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
875connections.
876
877A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
878to forward incoming connections.
879
880A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
881parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
882
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100883All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
884'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
885case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
886
887Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
888logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
889proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
890However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
891name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
892
893Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
894and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100895bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100896protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
897modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
898arbitrary criteria.
899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009014.1. Proxy keywords matrix
902--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200904The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
905limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
906they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
907limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100908marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200909option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200910and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
911with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
912specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200914
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100915 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
916------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
917acl - X X X
918appsession - - X X
919backlog X X X -
920balance X - X X
921bind - X X -
922bind-process X X X X
923block - X X X
924capture cookie - X X -
925capture request header - X X -
926capture response header - X X -
927clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
928contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
929cookie X - X X
930default-server X - X X
931default_backend X X X -
932description - X X X
933disabled X X X X
934dispatch - - X X
935enabled X X X X
936errorfile X X X X
937errorloc X X X X
938errorloc302 X X X X
939-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
940errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200941force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100942fullconn X - X X
943grace X X X X
944hash-type X - X X
945http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100946http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200947http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100948http-request - X X X
949id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200950ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100951log X X X X
952maxconn X X X -
953mode X X X X
954monitor fail - X X -
955monitor-net X X X -
956monitor-uri X X X -
957option abortonclose (*) X - X X
958option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
959option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
960option allbackups (*) X - X X
961option checkcache (*) X - X X
962option clitcpka (*) X X X -
963option contstats (*) X X X -
964option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
965option dontlognull (*) X X X -
966option forceclose (*) X X X X
967-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
968option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200969option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100970option http-server-close (*) X X X X
971option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
972option httpchk X - X X
973option httpclose (*) X X X X
974option httplog X X X X
975option http_proxy (*) X X X X
976option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200977option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100978option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
979option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
980option logasap (*) X X X -
981option mysql-check X - X X
982option nolinger (*) X X X X
983option originalto X X X X
984option persist (*) X - X X
985option redispatch (*) X - X X
986option smtpchk X - X X
987option socket-stats (*) X X X -
988option splice-auto (*) X X X X
989option splice-request (*) X X X X
990option splice-response (*) X X X X
991option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
992option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
993-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
994option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
995option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
996option tcpka X X X X
997option tcplog X X X X
998option transparent (*) X - X X
999persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1000rate-limit sessions X X X -
1001redirect - X X X
1002redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1003redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1004reqadd - X X X
1005reqallow - X X X
1006reqdel - X X X
1007reqdeny - X X X
1008reqiallow - X X X
1009reqidel - X X X
1010reqideny - X X X
1011reqipass - X X X
1012reqirep - X X X
1013reqisetbe - X X X
1014reqitarpit - X X X
1015reqpass - X X X
1016reqrep - X X X
1017-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1018reqsetbe - X X X
1019reqtarpit - X X X
1020retries X - X X
1021rspadd - X X X
1022rspdel - X X X
1023rspdeny - X X X
1024rspidel - X X X
1025rspideny - X X X
1026rspirep - X X X
1027rsprep - X X X
1028server - - X X
1029source X - X X
1030srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001031stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001032stats auth X - X X
1033stats enable X - X X
1034stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001035stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036stats realm X - X X
1037stats refresh X - X X
1038stats scope X - X X
1039stats show-desc X - X X
1040stats show-legends X - X X
1041stats show-node X - X X
1042stats uri X - X X
1043-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1044stick match - - X X
1045stick on - - X X
1046stick store-request - - X X
1047stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001048tcp-request connection - X X -
1049tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001050tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001051tcp-response content - - X X
1052tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001053timeout check X - X X
1054timeout client X X X -
1055timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1056timeout connect X - X X
1057timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1058timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1059timeout http-request X X X X
1060timeout queue X - X X
1061timeout server X - X X
1062timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1063timeout tarpit X X X X
1064transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1065use_backend - X X -
1066------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1067 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1071---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001072
1073This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1074
1075
1076acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1077 Declare or complete an access list.
1078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1079 no | yes | yes | yes
1080 Example:
1081 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1082 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1083 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001085 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001086
1087
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001088appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1089 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001090 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1092 no | no | yes | yes
1093 Arguments :
1094 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1095 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1096
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001097 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098 checked in each cookie value.
1099
1100 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1101 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1102 milliseconds.
1103
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001104 request-learn
1105 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1106 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1107 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1108 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1109 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1110 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1111
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001112 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1113 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1114 data following this prefix.
1115
1116 Example :
1117 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1118
1119 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1120 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1121
1122 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1123 2 modes are currently supported :
1124 - path-parameters :
1125 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1126 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1127 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1128 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1129 - query-string :
1130 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1131 query string.
1132
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001133 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1134 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1135 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1136 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001137 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1138 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1139 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001140 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1141 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1142
1143 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1144
1145 Example :
1146 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1147
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001148 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001149 and "ignore-persist"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150
1151
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001152backlog <conns>
1153 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1155 yes | yes | yes | no
1156 Arguments :
1157 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1158 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1159 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1160
1161 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1162 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1163 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1164 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1165 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1166 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1167 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1168 backlog parameter.
1169
1170 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1171 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1172 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1173
1174 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1175
1176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001177balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001178balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001179 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1181 yes | no | yes | yes
1182 Arguments :
1183 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1184 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1185 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1186 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1187
1188 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1189 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1190 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1191 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001192 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1193 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1194 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1195 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1196 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1197 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1198 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1199 it, so that you don't worry.
1200
1201 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1202 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1203 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1204 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1205 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1206 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1207 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1208 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001210 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1211 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1212 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1213 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1214 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1215 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1216 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1217 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001219 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1220 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1221 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1222 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1223 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1224 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1225 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1226 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001227 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001228 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001229 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1230 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1231 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232
1233 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1234 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1235 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1236 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1237 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1238 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1239 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001240 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1241 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1242 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001244 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1245 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1246 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1247 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1248 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1249 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1250 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1251 URIs start with a leading "/".
1252
1253 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1254 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1255 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1256 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001258 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001259 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1260
1261 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1262 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1263 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1264 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1265 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1266 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1267 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1268 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1269 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1270 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1271 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1272 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1273 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1274 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1275 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1276 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1277 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1278 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1279 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1280 be randomly balanced if at all.
1281
1282 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1283 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1284 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1285 server will receive the request.
1286
1287 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1288 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1289 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1290 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1291 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001292 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1293 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1294 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001295
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001296 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1297 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1298 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001299 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001300 algorithm is applied instead.
1301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001302 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001303 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1304 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1305 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1306
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001307 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1308 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1309 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1310
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001311 rdp-cookie
1312 rdp-cookie(name)
1313 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1314 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1315 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1316 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1317 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1318 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001319 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001320 used instead.
1321
1322 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1323 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1324 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1325 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1326
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001327 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1328 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1329 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1330
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001331 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001332 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1333 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001334
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001335 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001336 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001337
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001338 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1339 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1340 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001341
1342 Examples :
1343 balance roundrobin
1344 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001345 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001346 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1347 balance hdr(host)
1348 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001349
1350 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1351 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001353 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001354 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1355 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1356 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1357 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1358
1359 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1360 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1361 defaults to 16 kB.
1362
1363 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1364 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1365
1366 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1367 Round Robin.
1368
1369 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1370 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1371 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1372 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1373
1374 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1375
1376 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001377 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001378 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1379 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1380 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001381
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001382 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1383 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001384
1385
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001386bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1387bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1388bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1389bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1390bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1391bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1392bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001393bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001394bind /<path> [, ...]
1395bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1396bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1397bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001398 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1400 no | yes | yes | no
1401 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001402 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1403 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1404 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1405 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1406 special address "0.0.0.0".
1407
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001408 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1409 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001410 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1411 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1412 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001413 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1414 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1415 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1416 the range.
1417
1418 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1419 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1420 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1421 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1422 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1423 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1424 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1425 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1426 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001427
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001428 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1429 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1430 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1431 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1432 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1433 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1434 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1435 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1436
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001437 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1438 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1439 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1440 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1441 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1442 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1443 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1444 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001445 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1446 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001447
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001448 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1449 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1450 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1451 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1452 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1453 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
1454 work on other operating systems. The commonly advertised
1455 value on Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP).
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001456 This parameter is only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001457
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001458 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1459 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1460 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1461 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001462
1463 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1464
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001465 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1466 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1467 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1468 simply ignore this.
1469
1470 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1471 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1472 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1473 simply ignore this.
1474
1475 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1476 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1477 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1478 this.
1479
1480 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1481 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1482 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1483 this.
1484
1485 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1486 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1487 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1488 this.
1489
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001490 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1491 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1492 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001493 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001494 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1495 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1496 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1497 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001498 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1499 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001500
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001501 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001502 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1503 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1504 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1505 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1506 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1507 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1508 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1509 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1510 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1511 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1512 with front firewalls which would see an established
1513 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1514
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001515 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1516 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1517 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1518 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1519 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1520 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1521 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1522 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1523 This keyword combined with support from external components
1524 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1525 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1526 not even always usable.
1527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001528 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1529 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1530 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1531 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1532 in a frontend.
1533
1534 Example :
1535 listen http_proxy
1536 bind :80,:443
1537 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001538 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001539
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001540 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001541 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542
1543
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001544bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1545 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1547 yes | yes | yes | yes
1548 Arguments :
1549 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1550 may be used to override a default value.
1551
1552 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1553 option may be combined with other numbers.
1554
1555 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1556 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1557 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1558 missing from all processes.
1559
1560 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1561 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1562 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1563 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1564
1565 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1566 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1567 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1568 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1569 and 'even' instances.
1570
1571 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1572 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1573 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1574 32.
1575
1576 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1577 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1578
1579 Example :
1580 listen app_ip1
1581 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001582 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001583
1584 listen app_ip2
1585 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001586 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001587
1588 listen management
1589 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001590 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001591
1592 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1593
1594
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001595block { if | unless } <condition>
1596 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1598 no | yes | yes | yes
1599
1600 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1601 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001602 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001603 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1604 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1605 "block" statements per instance.
1606
1607 Example:
1608 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1609 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1610 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1611 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001613 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001614
1615
1616capture cookie <name> len <length>
1617 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1619 no | yes | yes | no
1620 Arguments :
1621 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1622 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1623 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1624 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1625 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1626
1627 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1628 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1629 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1630 right if it exceeds <length>.
1631
1632 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1633 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1634 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1635 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1636
1637 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1638 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1639 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1640
1641 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1642 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1643 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1644 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001645 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1647
1648 Example:
1649 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1650
1651 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001652 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001653
1654
1655capture request header <name> len <length>
1656 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1658 no | yes | yes | no
1659 Arguments :
1660 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001661 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001662 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1663 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1664 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1665
1666 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1667 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1668 it exceeds <length>.
1669
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001670 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001671 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1672 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001673 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1674 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1675 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1676 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001677 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001678 environments to find where the request came from.
1679
1680 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1681 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1682 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1683 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001684
1685 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1686 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1687 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1688 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1689
1690 Example:
1691 capture request header Host len 15
1692 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1693 capture request header Referrer len 15
1694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001695 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001696 about logging.
1697
1698
1699capture response header <name> len <length>
1700 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1702 no | yes | yes | no
1703 Arguments :
1704 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001705 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001706 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1707 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1708 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1709
1710 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1711 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1712 it exceeds <length>.
1713
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001714 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001715 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1716 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1717 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001718 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1719 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1720 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1721 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001722
1723 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1724 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1725 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1726 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1727
1728 Example:
1729 capture response header Content-length len 9
1730 capture response header Location len 15
1731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001732 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733 about logging.
1734
1735
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001736clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1739 yes | yes | yes | no
1740 Arguments :
1741 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1742 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1743 as explained at the top of this document.
1744
1745 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1746 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1747 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1748 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1749 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1750 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1751 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1752 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001753 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1755 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1756
1757 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1758 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1759 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1760 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1761 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1762 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1763
1764 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1765 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1766
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001767 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1768 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769
1770
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001771contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1774 yes | no | yes | yes
1775 Arguments :
1776 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1778 as explained at the top of this document.
1779
1780 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001781 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001782 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1784 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1785 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1786 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1787
1788 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1789 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1790 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1791 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1792 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1793 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1794
1795 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1796 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1797 instead.
1798
1799 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1800 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1801
1802
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001803cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001804 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001805 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1808 yes | no | yes | yes
1809 Arguments :
1810 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1811 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1812 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1813 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1814 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1815 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1816 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1817 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1818 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1819
1820 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1821 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1822 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1823 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1824 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1825 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1826 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1827 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1828 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1829 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1830 "insert" and "prefix".
1831
1832 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001833 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001834
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001835 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001836 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1837 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1838 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1839 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1840 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1841 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1842 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1843 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1844 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1845 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001846
1847 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1848 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1849 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1850 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1851 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1852 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1853 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1854 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1855 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1856 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1857 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1858
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001859 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1860 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1861 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001862 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1863 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1864 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1865 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001866
1867 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1868 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1869 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1870 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1871 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1872 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1873 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1874 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1875 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1876
1877 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1878 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1879 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1880 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1881 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1882 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1883 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1884 persistence cookie in the cache.
1885 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1886
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001887 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1888 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1889 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1890 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1891 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1892 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1893 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1894 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1895 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1896 they logout.
1897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001898 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001899 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001900 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1901 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1902 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1903 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1904 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1905 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001906
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001907 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1908 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1909 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1910 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1911 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1912 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1913 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1914 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1915 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1916 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1917 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1918 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1919 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1920 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1921 the site.
1922
1923 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1924 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1925 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1926 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1927 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1928 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1929 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1930 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1931 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1932 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1933 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1934 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1935 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1936 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1937 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1938 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001940 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1941 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1942 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1943 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001945 Examples :
1946 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1947 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1948 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001949 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001951 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001952 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001953
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001955default-server [param*]
1956 Change default options for a server in a backend
1957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1958 yes | no | yes | yes
1959 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001960 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1961 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1962 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1963 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001964
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001965 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001966 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1967
1968 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001971default_backend <backend>
1972 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1974 yes | yes | yes | no
1975 Arguments :
1976 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1977
1978 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1979 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1980 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1981 will catch all undetermined requests.
1982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001983 Example :
1984
1985 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1986 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1987 default_backend dynamic
1988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001989 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001991
1992disabled
1993 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1995 yes | yes | yes | yes
1996 Arguments : none
1997
1998 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
1999 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2000 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2001 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2002 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2003 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2004 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2005
2006 See also : "enabled"
2007
2008
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002009dispatch <address>:<port>
2010 Set a default server address
2011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2012 no | no | yes | yes
2013 Arguments : none
2014
2015 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2016 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2017 during start-up.
2018
2019 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2020 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2021 possible with normal servers.
2022
2023 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
2024 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2025 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2026 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2027 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2028
2029 See also : "server"
2030
2031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002032enabled
2033 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2035 yes | yes | yes | yes
2036 Arguments : none
2037
2038 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2039 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2040
2041 See also : "disabled"
2042
2043
2044errorfile <code> <file>
2045 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2047 yes | yes | yes | yes
2048 Arguments :
2049 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2050 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2051
2052 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002053 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002055 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2056 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
2058 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2059 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2060 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2061
2062 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2063 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2064 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2065 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2066
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002067 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2068 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2069 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2070 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2071 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2072 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2073
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2075 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2076 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002077 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2079
2080 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2081
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002082 Example :
2083 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2084 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2085 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2086
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002087
2088errorloc <code> <url>
2089errorloc302 <code> <url>
2090 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2092 yes | yes | yes | yes
2093 Arguments :
2094 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2095 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2096
2097 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2098 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2099 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2100 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2101 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2102
2103 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2104 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2105 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2106
2107 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2108 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2109 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2110 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2111 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2112 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2113 request.
2114
2115 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2116
2117
2118errorloc303 <code> <url>
2119 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2121 yes | yes | yes | yes
2122 Arguments :
2123 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2124 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2125
2126 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2127 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2128 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2129 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2130 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2131
2132 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2133 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2134 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2135
2136 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2137 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2138 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2139 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002140 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002141
2142 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2143
2144
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002145force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2146 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2148 no | yes | yes | yes
2149
2150 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2151 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2152 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2153 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2154 marked down for maintenance operations.
2155
2156 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2157 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2158 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2159 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2160 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2161 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2162 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2163 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2164 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2165
2166 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2167 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2168 is used.
2169
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002170 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002171 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002172
2173
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002174fullconn <conns>
2175 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2177 yes | no | yes | yes
2178 Arguments :
2179 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2180 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2181
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002182 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002183 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002184 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002185 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2186 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2187 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2188 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2189 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002190 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002191
2192 Example :
2193 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2194 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2195 # connections.
2196 backend dynamic
2197 fullconn 10000
2198 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2199 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2200
2201 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2202
2203
2204grace <time>
2205 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002207 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002208 Arguments :
2209 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2210 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2211 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2212
2213 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2214 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002215 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002216 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2217
2218 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2219 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2220 simplify it.
2221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002223hash-type <method>
2224 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2226 yes | no | yes | yes
2227 Arguments :
2228 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2229 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2230 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2231 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2232 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2233 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2234 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2235 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2236 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2237
2238 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2239 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2240 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2241 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2242 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2243 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2244 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2245 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2246 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2247 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2248 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2249 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2250 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2251
2252 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2253
2254 See also : "balance", "server"
2255
2256
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002257http-check disable-on-404
2258 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002260 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002261 Arguments : none
2262
2263 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2264 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2265 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2266 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2267 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2268 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2269 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2270 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002271 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2272 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2273 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2274
2275 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2276
2277
2278http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2279 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2281 no | no | yes | yes
2282 Arguments :
2283 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2284 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2285 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2286 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2287 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2288 details on the supported keywords.
2289
2290 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2291 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2292 with the usual backslash ('\').
2293
2294 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2295 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2296 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2297 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2298 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2299
2300 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2301 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2302 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2303 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2304 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2305
2306 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2307 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2308 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2309 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2310 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2311 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2312
2313 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2314 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2315 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2316 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2317 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2318 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2319 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2320 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2321 trace).
2322
2323 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2324 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2325 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2326 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2327 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2328 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2329 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2330 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2331
2332 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2333 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2334 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2335 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2336 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2337 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2338 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2339 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2340
2341 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2342 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2343
2344 Examples :
2345 # only accept status 200 as valid
2346 http-request expect status 200
2347
2348 # consider SQL errors as errors
2349 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2350
2351 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2352 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2353
2354 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2355 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002356
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002357 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002358
2359
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002360http-check send-state
2361 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2363 yes | no | yes | yes
2364 Arguments : none
2365
2366 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2367 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2368 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2369 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2370 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2371
2372 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2373 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2374 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2375 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2376 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2377 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2378 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2379 checked in multiple backends.
2380
2381 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2382 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2383
2384 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2385 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2386 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2387 one fails.
2388
2389 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2390 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2391 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2392
2393 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2394 server's queue.
2395
2396 Example of a header received by the application server :
2397 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2398 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2399
2400 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2401
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002402http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002403 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002404 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2405
2406 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2407 no | yes | yes | yes
2408
2409 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2410 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2411 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002412 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2413 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002414 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2415
2416 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2417 instance.
2418
2419 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002420 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2421 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2422 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002423
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002424 http-request allow if nagios
2425 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2426 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2427 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002428
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002429 Example:
2430 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002431
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002432 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002433
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002434 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2435 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002437id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002438 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 no | yes | yes | yes
2441 Arguments : none
2442
2443 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2444 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2445 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002446
2447
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002448ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2449 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2450 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 no | yes | yes | yes
2452
2453 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2454 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2455 and running).
2456
2457 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2458 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2459 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2460 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2461 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2462
2463 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2464 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2465
2466 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2467 "unless" condition is met.
2468
2469 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2470
2471
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002472log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002473log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002474 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2476 yes | yes | yes | yes
2477 Arguments :
2478 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2479 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2480 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2481 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2482 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2483 parameter.
2484
2485 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2486 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2487
2488 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2489 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2490 standard syslog port).
2491
2492 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2493 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2494 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2495 appropriately writeable).
2496
2497 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2498
2499 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2500 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2501 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2502
2503 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2504 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2505 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002506 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2507 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2508 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2509 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2510 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002511
2512 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2513
2514 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2515 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2516 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2517
2518 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002519 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2520 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2521 "info".
2522
2523 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2524 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2525 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2526 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2527
2528 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2529 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002530
2531 Example :
2532 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002533 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2534 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002535
2536
2537maxconn <conns>
2538 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2540 yes | yes | yes | no
2541 Arguments :
2542 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2543 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2544 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2545 closes.
2546
2547 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2548 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2549 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2550 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2551 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2552 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2553 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2554 properly tuned.
2555
2556 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2557 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2558 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2559
2560 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2561
2562
2563mode { tcp|http|health }
2564 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2566 yes | yes | yes | yes
2567 Arguments :
2568 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2569 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2570 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2571 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2572
2573 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2574 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2575 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2576 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2577 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2578
2579 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2580 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2581 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2582 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2583 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2584 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2585
2586 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2587 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2588 will be refused.
2589
2590 Example :
2591 defaults http_instances
2592 mode http
2593
2594 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2595
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002596
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002597monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002598 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2600 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601 Arguments :
2602 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2603 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002604 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002605 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2606 backend and its backup.
2607
2608 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2609 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2610 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2611 servers in a list of backends.
2612
2613 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2614 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2615 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2616 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2617 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2618 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2619 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002620 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002621
2622 Example:
2623 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002624 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002625 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2626 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2627 monitor-uri /site_alive
2628 monitor fail if site_dead
2629
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002630 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2631
2632
2633monitor-net <source>
2634 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2636 yes | yes | yes | no
2637 Arguments :
2638 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2639 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2640 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2641 followed by a mask.
2642
2643 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2644 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002645 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2647
2648 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2649 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2650 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2651 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2652 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2653
2654 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2655 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2656 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2657 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2658 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2659
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002660 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2661 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2662
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002663 Example :
2664 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2665 frontend www
2666 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2667
2668 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2669
2670
2671monitor-uri <uri>
2672 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2674 yes | yes | yes | no
2675 Arguments :
2676 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2677 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2678
2679 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2680 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2681 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2682 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2683 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2684 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2685 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2686 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2687
2688 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2689 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2690 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2691 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2692 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2693 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2694
2695 Example :
2696 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2697 frontend www
2698 mode http
2699 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2700
2701 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002704option abortonclose
2705no option abortonclose
2706 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2708 yes | no | yes | yes
2709 Arguments : none
2710
2711 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2712 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2713 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2714 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002715 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002716 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2717 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2718 encountered while delivering the response.
2719
2720 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2721 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2722 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2723 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2724 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2725 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002726 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002727 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002728 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002729 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2730 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2731 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2732
2733 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2734 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2735 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2736 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2737 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2738 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2739 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2740 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002741 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002742
2743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2745
2746 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2747
2748
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002749option accept-invalid-http-request
2750no option accept-invalid-http-request
2751 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2753 yes | yes | yes | no
2754 Arguments : none
2755
2756 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2757 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2758 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2759 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2760 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2761 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2762 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2763 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2764 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2765
2766 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2767 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2768 been confirmed.
2769
2770 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2771 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2772 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2773 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2774
2775 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2776 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2777
2778 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2779 stats socket.
2780
2781
2782option accept-invalid-http-response
2783no option accept-invalid-http-response
2784 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2786 yes | no | yes | yes
2787 Arguments : none
2788
2789 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2790 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2791 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2792 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2793 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2794 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2795 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2796 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2797 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2798
2799 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2800 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2801 been confirmed.
2802
2803 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2804 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2805 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2806 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2807
2808 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2809 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2810
2811 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2812 stats socket.
2813
2814
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002815option allbackups
2816no option allbackups
2817 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2819 yes | no | yes | yes
2820 Arguments : none
2821
2822 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2823 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2824 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2825 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2826 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2827 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2828 order between the backup servers anymore.
2829
2830 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2831 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2832
2833 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2834 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2835
2836
2837option checkcache
2838no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002839 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2841 yes | no | yes | yes
2842 Arguments : none
2843
2844 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2845 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002846 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002847 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2848 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2849 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2850
2851 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002853 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002854 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2855 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002856 to the client are :
2857 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002858 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002859 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002860 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2861 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2862 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2863 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2864 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2865 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2866 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2867 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2868 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2869 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2870 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2871
2872 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002873 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002874 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002875 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002876 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2877
2878 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2879 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002880 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002881 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2882
2883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2885
2886
2887option clitcpka
2888no option clitcpka
2889 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2891 yes | yes | yes | no
2892 Arguments : none
2893
2894 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2895 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2896 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2897 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2898
2899 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2900 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2901 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2902 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2903
2904 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2905 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2906 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2907 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2908 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2909
2910 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2911
2912 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2913 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2914 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2915
2916 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2917 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2918
2919 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2920
2921
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002922option contstats
2923 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2925 yes | yes | yes | no
2926 Arguments : none
2927
2928 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2929 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2930 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2931 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2932 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2933 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2934 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2935
2936
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002937option dontlog-normal
2938no option dontlog-normal
2939 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2941 yes | yes | yes | no
2942 Arguments : none
2943
2944 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2945 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2946 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2947 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2948 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2949 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2950 logged.
2951
2952 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2953 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2954 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002956 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002957 logging.
2958
2959
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002960option dontlognull
2961no option dontlognull
2962 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2964 yes | yes | yes | no
2965 Arguments : none
2966
2967 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
2968 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
2969 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
2970 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
2971 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
2972 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
2973 which typically corresponds to those probes.
2974
2975 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
2976 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
2977 would not be logged.
2978
2979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002982 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002983
2984
2985option forceclose
2986no option forceclose
2987 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
2988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01002989 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002990 Arguments : none
2991
2992 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
2993 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
2994 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
2995 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
2996 global session times in the logs.
2997
2998 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01002999 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003000 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3001 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3002 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3003 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003004
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003005 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3006 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3007 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003009 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3010 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3011
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003012 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003013
3014
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003015option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003016 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3018 yes | yes | yes | yes
3019 Arguments :
3020 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3021 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003022 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003023 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003024
3025 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3026 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3027 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3028 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3029 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3030 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3031 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003032 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3033 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3034 possible that the client has already brought one.
3035
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003036 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003037 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003038 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3039 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003040 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3041 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003042
3043 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3044 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3045 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3046 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3047 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3048 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3049 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3050
3051 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003052 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3053 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3054 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003055
3056 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3057 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3058 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3059 when using this option.
3060
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003061 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003062 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3063 frontend www
3064 mode http
3065 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3066
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003067 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3068 backend www
3069 mode http
3070 option forwardfor header X-Client
3071
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003072 See also : "option httpclose"
3073
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003074
3075option http-pretend-keepalive
3076no option http-pretend-keepalive
3077 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3079 yes | yes | yes | yes
3080 Arguments : none
3081
3082 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3083 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3084 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3085 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3086 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3087 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3088 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3089 consider the response complete.
3090
3091 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3092 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3093 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3094 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3095 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3096 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3097
3098 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3099 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3100 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3101 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3102 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3103 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3104 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3105
3106 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3107 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003108 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3109 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3110 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003111
3112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3114
3115 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3116
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003117
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003118option http-server-close
3119no option http-server-close
3120 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3122 yes | yes | yes | yes
3123 Arguments : none
3124
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003125 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3126 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3127 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3128 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3129 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3130 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3131 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3132 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3133 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3134 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3135 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3136 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003137
3138 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3139 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3140 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3141 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003142 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3143 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003144
3145 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3146 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003147 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3148 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3149 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003150
3151 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3152 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3153
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003154 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3155 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003156
3157
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003158option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003159no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003160 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3162 yes | yes | yes | no
3163 Arguments : none
3164
3165 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3166 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3167 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3168 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3169 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3170 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3171 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3172
3173 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3174 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3175 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3176 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3177 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3178 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3179 request along its whole life.
3180
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003181 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3182 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3183 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3184 front of an existing proxy.
3185
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003186 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3187
3188 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3189 http-server-close".
3190
3191
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003192option httpchk
3193option httpchk <uri>
3194option httpchk <method> <uri>
3195option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3196 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3198 yes | no | yes | yes
3199 Arguments :
3200 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3201 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3202 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3203 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3204 ones.
3205
3206 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3207 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3208 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3209
3210 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3211 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3212 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3213 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3214 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3215
3216 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3217 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3218 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3219 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3220 the lack of any response.
3221
3222 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3223
3224 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3225 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3226 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3227
3228 Examples :
3229 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3230 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3231 backend https_relay
3232 mode tcp
3233 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3234 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3235
3236 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3237 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3238
3239
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003240option httpclose
3241no option httpclose
3242 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | yes
3245 Arguments : none
3246
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003247 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3248 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3249 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3250 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3251 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3252 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3253 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003254
3255 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003256 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3257 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3258 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3259 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3260 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3261 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003262
3263 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3264 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3265 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003266 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3267 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003268
3269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3271
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003272 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3273 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003274
3275
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003276option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003277 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3279 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003280 Arguments :
3281 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3282 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3283 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3284 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3285 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003286
3287 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3288 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3289 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3290 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3291 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3292 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3293 ports.
3294
3295 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3296
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003297 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3298 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3299 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3300 by default.
3301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003302 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003303
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003304
3305option http_proxy
3306no option http_proxy
3307 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3309 yes | yes | yes | yes
3310 Arguments : none
3311
3312 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3313 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3314 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3315 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3316 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3317
3318 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3319 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3320 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3321 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
3322 needed to add "option http_close" to ensure that all requests will correctly
3323 be analyzed.
3324
3325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3327
3328 Example :
3329 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3330 backend direct_forward
3331 option httpclose
3332 option http_proxy
3333
3334 See also : "option httpclose"
3335
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003336
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003337option ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3338 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3339 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3340 no | yes | yes | yes
3341
3342 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3343 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3344 and running).
3345
3346 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3347 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3348 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3349 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3350 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3351
3352 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3353 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3354
3355 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3356 "unless" condition is met.
3357
3358 See also : "option force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3359
3360
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003361option independant-streams
3362no option independant-streams
3363 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3365 yes | yes | yes | yes
3366 Arguments : none
3367
3368 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3369 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3370 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3371 receive data or not.
3372
3373 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3374 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3375 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3376 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3377 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3378 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3379 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3380 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3381 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3382 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3383 socket buffers.
3384
3385 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3386 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3387 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3388 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3389 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3390
3391 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3392
3393
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003394option ldap-check
3395 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3397 yes | no | yes | yes
3398 Arguments : none
3399
3400 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3401 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3402 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3403 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3404
3405 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3406 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3407
3408 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3409 configure it.
3410
3411 Example :
3412 option ldap-check
3413
3414 See also : "option httpchk"
3415
3416
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003417option log-health-checks
3418no option log-health-checks
3419 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3421 yes | no | yes | yes
3422 Arguments : none
3423
3424 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3425 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3426 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3427 of additional information is limited.
3428
3429 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3430 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3431
3432 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3433
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003434
3435option log-separate-errors
3436no option log-separate-errors
3437 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 yes | yes | yes | no
3440 Arguments : none
3441
3442 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3443 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3444 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3445 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3446 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3447 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3448 provides very important information.
3449
3450 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3451 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3452 error logs.
3453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003454 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003455 logging.
3456
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003457
3458option logasap
3459no option logasap
3460 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3462 yes | yes | yes | no
3463 Arguments : none
3464
3465 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3466 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3467 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3468 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3469 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3470 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3471 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003472 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003473 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3474 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3475
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003476 Examples :
3477 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3478 mode http
3479 option httplog
3480 option logasap
3481 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3482
3483 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3484 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3485 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3486 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003488 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003489 logging.
3490
3491
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003492option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3493 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003496 Arguments :
3497 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3498 to MySQL server.
3499
3500 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3501 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3502 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3503 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3504 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3505 in the MySQL table, like this :
3506
3507 USE mysql;
3508 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3509 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3510
3511 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3512 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3513 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3514 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3515 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3516 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3517 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3518 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3519 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3520
3521 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3522 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003523
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003524 The check requires MySQL >=4.0, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003525
3526 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3527 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3528 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3529 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3530 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3531 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3532
3533 See also: "option httpchk"
3534
3535
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003536option nolinger
3537no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003538 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3540 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003541 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003542
3543 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3544 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3545 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3546 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3547 connections.
3548
3549 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3550 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3551 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3552 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3553 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3554 this too.
3555
3556 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3557 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3558 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3559
3560 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3561 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3562 for servers.
3563
3564 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3565 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3566
3567
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003568option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3569 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3571 yes | yes | yes | yes
3572 Arguments :
3573 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3574 matching <network>
3575 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3576 header name.
3577
3578 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3579 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3580 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3581 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3582 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3583 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3584 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3585 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3586 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3587 possible that the client has already brought one.
3588
3589 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3590 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3591 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3592 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3593 header and requires different one.
3594
3595 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3596 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3597 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3598 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3599 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3600 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3601 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3602
3603 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3604 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3605 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3606 both are defined.
3607
3608 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3609 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3610 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3611 when using this option.
3612
3613 Examples :
3614 # Original Destination address
3615 frontend www
3616 mode http
3617 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3618
3619 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3620 backend www
3621 mode http
3622 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3623
3624 See also : "option httpclose"
3625
3626
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003627option persist
3628no option persist
3629 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3630 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3631 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003632 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003633
3634 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3635 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3636 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3637 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3638 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3639 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3640 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3641 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3642 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3643 redirected to another valid server.
3644
3645 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3646 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3647
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003648 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003649
3650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003651option redispatch
3652no option redispatch
3653 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003656 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003657
3658 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3659 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3660 be able to access the service anymore.
3661
3662 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3663 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3664
3665 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3666 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3667 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003669 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3670 "redisp" keywords.
3671
3672 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3673 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3674
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003675 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003676
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003677
3678option smtpchk
3679option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3680 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3682 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003683 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003684 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3685 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3686 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3687
3688 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3689 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3690 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3691
3692 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3693 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3694 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3695 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3696 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3697 dead server.
3698
3699 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3700 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3701 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3702 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3703
3704 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3705 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3706 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3707 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3708 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3709
3710 Example :
3711 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3712
3713 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003716option socket-stats
3717no option socket-stats
3718
3719 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | yes | yes | no
3722
3723 Arguments : none
3724
3725
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003726option splice-auto
3727no option splice-auto
3728 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 yes | yes | yes | yes
3731 Arguments : none
3732
3733 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3734 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3735 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3736 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003737 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003738 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3739 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3740 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3741 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3742
3743 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3744 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3745 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3746 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3747 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3748 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3749 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3750 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3751 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3752 keyword.
3753
3754 Example :
3755 option splice-auto
3756
3757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3759
3760 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3761 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3762
3763
3764option splice-request
3765no option splice-request
3766 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3768 yes | yes | yes | yes
3769 Arguments : none
3770
3771 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3772 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3773 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3774 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3775 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3776 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3777
3778 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3779
3780 Example :
3781 option splice-request
3782
3783 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3784 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3785
3786 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3787 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3788
3789
3790option splice-response
3791no option splice-response
3792 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3794 yes | yes | yes | yes
3795 Arguments : none
3796
3797 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3798 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3799 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3800 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3801 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3802 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3803
3804 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3805
3806 Example :
3807 option splice-response
3808
3809 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3810 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3811
3812 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3813 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3814
3815
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003816option srvtcpka
3817no option srvtcpka
3818 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3820 yes | no | yes | yes
3821 Arguments : none
3822
3823 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3824 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3825 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3826 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3827
3828 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3829 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3830 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3831 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3832
3833 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3834 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3835 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3836 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3837 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3838
3839 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3840
3841 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3842 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3843 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3844
3845 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3846 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3847
3848 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3849
3850
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003851option ssl-hello-chk
3852 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3854 yes | no | yes | yes
3855 Arguments : none
3856
3857 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3858 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3859 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3860 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3861 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3862 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3863 hello message.
3864
3865 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3866 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3867 messages, which is appreciable.
3868
3869 See also: "option httpchk"
3870
3871
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003872option tcp-smart-accept
3873no option tcp-smart-accept
3874 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | yes | yes | no
3877 Arguments : none
3878
3879 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3880 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3881 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3882 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3883 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3884 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3885
3886 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3887 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3888 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3889 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3890
3891 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3892 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3893 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3894 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3895
3896 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3897 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3898 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3899
3900 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3901 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3902 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3903
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003904 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3905
3906
3907option tcp-smart-connect
3908no option tcp-smart-connect
3909 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | no | yes | yes
3912 Arguments : none
3913
3914 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3915 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3916 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3917 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3918 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3919
3920 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3921 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3922 complex.
3923
3924 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3925 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3926 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3927
3928 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3929 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3930
3931 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3932
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003933
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003934option tcpka
3935 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3937 yes | yes | yes | yes
3938 Arguments : none
3939
3940 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3941 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3942 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3943 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3944
3945 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3946 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3947 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3948 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3949
3950 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3951 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3952 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3953 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3954 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3955
3956 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3957
3958 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3959 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3960 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3961 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3962 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3963 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3964 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3965 backends.
3966
3967 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3968
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003969
3970option tcplog
3971 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3973 yes | yes | yes | yes
3974 Arguments : none
3975
3976 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3977 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3978 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3979 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3980 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3981 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3982 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3983 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3984
3985 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003987 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003988
3989
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003990option transparent
3991no option transparent
3992 Enable client-side transparent proxying
3993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01003994 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003995 Arguments : none
3996
3997 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
3998 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
3999 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4000 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4001 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4002 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4003 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4004 appropriate server.
4005
4006 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4007 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4008
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004009 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
4010 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004011
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004012
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004013persist rdp-cookie
4014persist rdp-cookie(name)
4015 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4017 yes | no | yes | yes
4018 Arguments :
4019 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004020 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4021 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004022
4023 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4024 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4025 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4026 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4027 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4028 forwarded to this server.
4029
4030 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4031 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4032 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004033 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004034 a single "listen" section.
4035
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004036 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4037 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4038 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4039
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004040 Example :
4041 listen tse-farm
4042 bind :3389
4043 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4044 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4045 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4046 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4047 persist rdp-cookie
4048 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4049 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4050 balance rdp-cookie
4051 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4052 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4053
4054 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
4055
4056
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004057rate-limit sessions <rate>
4058 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4060 yes | yes | yes | no
4061 Arguments :
4062 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4063 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4064
4065 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4066 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4067 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4068 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4069 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4070 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4071
4072 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4073 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4074 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4075 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4076
4077 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4078 listen smtp
4079 mode tcp
4080 bind :25
4081 rate-limit sessions 10
4082 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4083
4084 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4085 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4086
4087 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4088
4089
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004090redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4091redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004092 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4094 no | yes | yes | yes
4095
4096 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004097 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004098
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004099 Arguments :
4100 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4101 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4102 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4103 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004104 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4105 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4106 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4107 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004108
4109 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4110 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4111 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4112 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4113 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4114 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4115 location with a GET method.
4116
4117 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4118 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4119
4120 - "drop-query"
4121 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4122 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4123 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4124 with a location-type redirect.
4125
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004126 - "append-slash"
4127 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4128 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4129 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4130 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4131
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004132 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4133 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4134 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4135 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4136 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4137 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4138 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4139
4140 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4141 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4142 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4143 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4144 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4145 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4146 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004147
4148 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4149 acl clear dst_port 80
4150 acl secure dst_port 8080
4151 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004152 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004153 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004154 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4155
4156 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004157 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4158 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4159 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004160 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004161
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004162 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4163 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4164 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004166 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004167
4168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004169redisp (deprecated)
4170redispatch (deprecated)
4171 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4172 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4173 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004174 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004175
4176 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4177 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4178 be able to access the service anymore.
4179
4180 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4181 redistribute them to a working server.
4182
4183 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4184 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4185 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004187 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4188 "option redispatch" instead.
4189
4190 See also : "option redispatch"
4191
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004192
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004193reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004194 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4196 no | yes | yes | yes
4197 Arguments :
4198 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4199 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004200 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004201
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004202 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4203 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4204
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004205 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4206 the last header of an HTTP request.
4207
4208 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4209 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4210 responses.
4211
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004212 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4213 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4214 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4215
4216 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4217 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004218
4219
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004220reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4221reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004222 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 no | yes | yes | yes
4225 Arguments :
4226 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4227 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4228 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4229 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4230 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4231 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4232 ignores case.
4233
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004234 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4235 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4236
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004237 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4238 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4239 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4240 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004241 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004242
4243 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4244 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4245
4246 Example :
4247 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4248 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4249 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4250
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004251 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4252 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004253
4254
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004255reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4256reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004257 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4259 no | yes | yes | yes
4260 Arguments :
4261 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4262 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4263 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4264 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4265 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4266 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4267
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004268 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4269 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4270
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004271 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4272 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4273 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4274 next servers.
4275
4276 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4277 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4278 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4279
4280 Example :
4281 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4282 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4283 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4284
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004285 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4286 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004287
4288
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004289reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4290reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004291 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4293 no | yes | yes | yes
4294 Arguments :
4295 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4296 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4297 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4298 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4299 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4300 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4301 case.
4302
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004303 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4304 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4305
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004306 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4307 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4308 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4309 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004310 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004311
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004312 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004313 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004314 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004315
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004316 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4317 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4318
4319 Example :
4320 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4321 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4322 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4323
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004324 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4325 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004326
4327
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004328reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4329reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004330 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4332 no | yes | yes | yes
4333 Arguments :
4334 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4335 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4336 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4337 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4338 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4339 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4340 case.
4341
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004342 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4343 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4344
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004345 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4346 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4347 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4348 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4349
4350 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4351 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4352
4353 Example :
4354 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4355 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4356 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4357 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4358
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004359 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4360 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004361
4362
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004363reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4364reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004365 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 no | yes | yes | yes
4368 Arguments :
4369 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4370 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4371 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4372 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4373 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4374 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4375
4376 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4377 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4378 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4379 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004380 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004381
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004382 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4383 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4384
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004385 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4386 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4387 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4388
4389 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4390 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4391 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4392 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4393 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4394
4395 Example :
4396 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4397 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4398 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4399 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4400
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004401 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4402 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004403
4404
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004405reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4406reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004407 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4409 no | yes | yes | yes
4410 Arguments :
4411 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4412 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4413 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4414 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4415 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4416 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4417 ignores case.
4418
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004419 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4420 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4421
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004422 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4423 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004424 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4425 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4426 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004427 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4428 not set.
4429
4430 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4431 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4432 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4433 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4434 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4435
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004436 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004437 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4438 # block all others.
4439 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4440 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4441
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004442 # block bad guys
4443 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4444 reqitarpit . if badguys
4445
4446 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4447 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004448
4449
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004450retries <value>
4451 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4452 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4453 yes | no | yes | yes
4454 Arguments :
4455 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4456 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4457 default value is 3.
4458
4459 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4460 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4461 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4462
4463 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4464 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4465
4466 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4467 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4468
4469 See also : "option redispatch"
4470
4471
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004472rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004473 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4475 no | yes | yes | yes
4476 Arguments :
4477 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4478 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004479 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004480
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004481 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4482 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4483
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004484 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4485 the last header of an HTTP response.
4486
4487 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4488 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4489 responses.
4490
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004491 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4492 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004493
4494
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004495rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4496rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004497 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4499 no | yes | yes | yes
4500 Arguments :
4501 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4502 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4503 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4504 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4505 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4506 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4507 ignores case.
4508
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004509 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4510 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4511
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004512 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4513 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4514 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4515 client.
4516
4517 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4518 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4519 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4520
4521 Example :
4522 # remove the Server header from responses
4523 reqidel ^Server:.*
4524
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004525 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4526 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004527
4528
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004529rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4530rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004531 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4533 no | yes | yes | yes
4534 Arguments :
4535 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4536 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4537 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4538 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4539 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4540 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4541 ignores case.
4542
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004543 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4544 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4545
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004546 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4547 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4548 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4549 case-sensitive.
4550
4551 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004552 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4553 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4554 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004555
4556 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4557 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4558
4559 Example :
4560 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4561 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4562
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004563 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4564 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004565
4566
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004567rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4568rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004569 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4571 no | yes | yes | yes
4572 Arguments :
4573 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4574 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4575 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4576 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4577 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4578 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4579 ignores case.
4580
4581 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4582 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4583 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4584 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004585 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004586
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004587 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4588 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4589
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004590 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4591 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4592 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4593
4594 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4595 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4596 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4597 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4598 are not case-sensitive.
4599
4600 Example :
4601 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4602 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4603
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004604 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4605 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004606
4607
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004608server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4609 Declare a server in a backend
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 no | no | yes | yes
4612 Arguments :
4613 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4614 appear in logs and alerts.
4615
4616 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4617 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004618 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4619 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4620 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4621 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4622 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4623 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4624 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4625 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004626
4627 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4628 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4629 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4630 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4631 adding this value to the client's port.
4632
4633 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4634 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004635 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004636
4637 Examples :
4638 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4639 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004641 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004642
4643
4644source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004645source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004646source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004647 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4649 yes | no | yes | yes
4650 Arguments :
4651 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4652 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4653 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4654 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4655
4656 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4657 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004658 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4659 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4660 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004661
4662 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4663 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4664 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4665 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4666 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4667 <addr>.
4668
4669 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4670 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4671 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4672 port.
4673
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004674 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4675 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4676 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4677 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4678 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4679 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4680 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4681 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4682 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4683 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4684 HTTP header.
4685
4686 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4687 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4688 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4689 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4690 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4691 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4692 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4693 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4694 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4695 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4696
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004697 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4698 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4699 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4700 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4701 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4702 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4703
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004704 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4705 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4706 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4707 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4708
4709 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4710 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4711 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4712 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4713 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4714 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4715
4716 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4717 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4718 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4719 there are two methods :
4720
4721 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4722 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4723 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4724 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4725 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4726 of the client ranges may be used.
4727
4728 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4729 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4730 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4731 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4732 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4733 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4734 same session.
4735
4736 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4737 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4738 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4739 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4740 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4741 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4742
4743 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4744 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4745 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004746 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004747
4748 Examples :
4749 backend private
4750 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4751 source 192.168.1.200
4752
4753 backend transparent_ssl1
4754 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4755 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4756
4757 backend transparent_ssl2
4758 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4759 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4760 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4761
4762 backend transparent_ssl3
4763 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4764 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4765 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4766
4767 backend transparent_smtp
4768 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4769 # with Tproxy version 4.
4770 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4771
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004772 backend transparent_http
4773 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4774 # proxy.
4775 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004777 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004778 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004780
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004781srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4782 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 yes | no | yes | yes
4785 Arguments :
4786 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4787 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4788 as explained at the top of this document.
4789
4790 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4791 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4792 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4793 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4794 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4795 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4796 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4797
4798 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4799 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4800 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4801 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4802 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004803 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004804 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004805 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004806
4807 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4808 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4809 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4810 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4811 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4812 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4813
4814 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4815 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4816
4817 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4818
4819
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004820stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4821 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4823 no | no | yes | yes
4824
4825 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4826 matched.
4827
4828 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4829 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4830
4831 Currently, there are 2 known limitations :
4832
4833 - The POST data are limited to one packet, which means that if the list of
4834 servers is too long, the request won't be processed. It is recommended
4835 to alter few servers at a time.
4836
4837 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported.
4838
4839 Example :
4840 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4841 backend stats_localhost
4842 stats enable
4843 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4844
4845 Example :
4846 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4847 backend stats_auth
4848 stats enable
4849 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4850 stats admin if TRUE
4851
4852 Example :
4853 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4854 userlist stats-auth
4855 group admin users admin
4856 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4857 group readonly users haproxy
4858 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4859
4860 backend stats_auth
4861 stats enable
4862 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4863 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4864 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4865 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4866
4867 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
4868 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
4869
4870
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004871stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4872 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4874 yes | no | yes | yes
4875 Arguments :
4876 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4877
4878 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4879
4880 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4881 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4882 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4883 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4884 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4885 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4886
4887 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4888 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4889 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4890 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4891
4892 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4893 report using "stats scope".
4894
4895 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4896 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4897 unobvious parameters.
4898
4899 Example :
4900 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4901 backend public_www
4902 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4903 stats enable
4904 stats hide-version
4905 stats scope .
4906 stats uri /admin?stats
4907 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4908 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4909 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4910
4911 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4912 backend private_monitoring
4913 stats enable
4914 stats uri /admin?stats
4915 stats refresh 5s
4916
4917 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4918
4919
4920stats enable
4921 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4923 yes | no | yes | yes
4924 Arguments : none
4925
4926 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4927 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4928 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4929 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4930 - stats auth : no authentication
4931 - stats scope : no restriction
4932
4933 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4934 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4935 unobvious parameters.
4936
4937 Example :
4938 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4939 backend public_www
4940 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4941 stats enable
4942 stats hide-version
4943 stats scope .
4944 stats uri /admin?stats
4945 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4946 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4947 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4948
4949 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4950 backend private_monitoring
4951 stats enable
4952 stats uri /admin?stats
4953 stats refresh 5s
4954
4955 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4956
4957
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004958stats hide-version
4959 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4961 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004962 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004963
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004964 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4965 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4966 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4967 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4968 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4969 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004971 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4972 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4973 unobvious parameters.
4974
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004975 Example :
4976 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4977 backend public_www
4978 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004979 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004980 stats hide-version
4981 stats scope .
4982 stats uri /admin?stats
4983 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4984 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4985 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004986
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004987 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4988 backend private_monitoring
4989 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004990 stats uri /admin?stats
4991 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01004992
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004993 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004994
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004995
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004996stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
4997 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4998 Access control for statistics
4999
5000 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 no | no | yes | yes
5002
5003 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5004 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5005 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5006 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5007 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5008 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5009
5010 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5011 instance.
5012
5013 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5014 about ACL usage.
5015
5016
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005017stats realm <realm>
5018 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5020 yes | no | yes | yes
5021 Arguments :
5022 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5023 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5024 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5025
5026 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5027 using a backslash ('\').
5028
5029 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5030 only related to authentication.
5031
5032 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5033 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5034 unobvious parameters.
5035
5036 Example :
5037 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5038 backend public_www
5039 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5040 stats enable
5041 stats hide-version
5042 stats scope .
5043 stats uri /admin?stats
5044 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5045 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5046 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5047
5048 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5049 backend private_monitoring
5050 stats enable
5051 stats uri /admin?stats
5052 stats refresh 5s
5053
5054 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5055
5056
5057stats refresh <delay>
5058 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5060 yes | no | yes | yes
5061 Arguments :
5062 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5063 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5064 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5065 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5066 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5067 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5068
5069 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5070 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5071 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5072 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5073
5074 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5075 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5076 unobvious parameters.
5077
5078 Example :
5079 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5080 backend public_www
5081 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5082 stats enable
5083 stats hide-version
5084 stats scope .
5085 stats uri /admin?stats
5086 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5087 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5088 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5089
5090 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5091 backend private_monitoring
5092 stats enable
5093 stats uri /admin?stats
5094 stats refresh 5s
5095
5096 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5097
5098
5099stats scope { <name> | "." }
5100 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 yes | no | yes | yes
5103 Arguments :
5104 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5105 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5106 section in which the statement appears.
5107
5108 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5109 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5110 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5111 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5112 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5113 exists.
5114
5115 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5116 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5117 unobvious parameters.
5118
5119 Example :
5120 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5121 backend public_www
5122 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5123 stats enable
5124 stats hide-version
5125 stats scope .
5126 stats uri /admin?stats
5127 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5128 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5129 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5130
5131 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5132 backend private_monitoring
5133 stats enable
5134 stats uri /admin?stats
5135 stats refresh 5s
5136
5137 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5138
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005139
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005140stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005141 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5143 yes | no | yes | yes
5144
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005145 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005146 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5147
5148 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5149 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5150
5151 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5152 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5153 unobvious parameters.
5154
5155 Example :
5156 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5157 backend private_monitoring
5158 stats enable
5159 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5160 stats uri /admin?stats
5161 stats refresh 5s
5162
5163 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5164 global section.
5165
5166
5167stats show-legends
5168 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5169 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5170 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5171 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5172 - IP (socket, server)
5173 - cookie (backend, server)
5174
5175 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5176 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5177 unobvious parameters.
5178
5179 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5180
5181
5182stats show-node [ <name> ]
5183 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5185 yes | no | yes | yes
5186 Arguments:
5187 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5188 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5189
5190 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5191 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5192 provided for each customer.
5193
5194 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5195 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5196 unobvious parameters.
5197
5198 Example:
5199 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5200 backend private_monitoring
5201 stats enable
5202 stats show-node Europe-1
5203 stats uri /admin?stats
5204 stats refresh 5s
5205
5206 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5207 section.
5208
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005209
5210stats uri <prefix>
5211 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5213 yes | no | yes | yes
5214 Arguments :
5215 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5216 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5217 query string.
5218
5219 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5220 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5221 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5222 possible to reach it in the application.
5223
5224 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005225 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005226 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5227 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5228 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5229 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5230
5231 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5232 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5233 an address or a port to statistics only.
5234
5235 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5236 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5237 unobvious parameters.
5238
5239 Example :
5240 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5241 backend public_www
5242 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5243 stats enable
5244 stats hide-version
5245 stats scope .
5246 stats uri /admin?stats
5247 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5248 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5249 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5250
5251 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5252 backend private_monitoring
5253 stats enable
5254 stats uri /admin?stats
5255 stats refresh 5s
5256
5257 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5258
5259
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005260stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5261 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005263 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005264
5265 Arguments :
5266 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5267 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5268 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5269 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5270
5271 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5272 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5273 the "stick-table" statement.
5274
5275 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5276 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5277 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5278 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5279 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5280
5281 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5282 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5283 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5284 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5285 transformation rules.
5286
5287 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5288 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5289 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5290 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5291 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5292 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5293 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5294
5295 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5296 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5297 ACL based conditions.
5298
5299 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5300 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5301 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5302 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5303
5304 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5305 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5306 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5307 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5308
5309 Example :
5310 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5311 # last 30 minutes
5312 backend pop
5313 mode tcp
5314 balance roundrobin
5315 stick store-request src
5316 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5317 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5318 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5319
5320 backend smtp
5321 mode tcp
5322 balance roundrobin
5323 stick match src table pop
5324 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5325 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5326
5327 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5328 extraction.
5329
5330
5331stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5332 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5334 no | no | yes | yes
5335
5336 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5337 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5338 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5339 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5340
5341 Examples :
5342 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005343 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005344
5345 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5346 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5347 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5348
5349
5350 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5351 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5352 backend http
5353 mode http
5354 balance roundrobin
5355 stick on src table https
5356 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5357 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5358 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5359
5360 backend https
5361 mode tcp
5362 balance roundrobin
5363 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5364 stick on src
5365 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5366 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5367
5368 See also : "stick match" and "stick store-request"
5369
5370
5371stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5372 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5374 no | no | yes | yes
5375
5376 Arguments :
5377 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5378 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5379 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5380 server is selected.
5381
5382 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5383 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5384 the "stick-table" statement.
5385
5386 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5387 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5388 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5389 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5390 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5391 address.
5392
5393 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5394 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5395 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5396 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5397 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5398 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5399 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5400 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5401 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5402 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5403
5404 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5405 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5406 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5407 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5408 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5409 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5410 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5411
5412 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5413 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5414 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5415 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5416
5417 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5418 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5419 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5420 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5421 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5422 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5423 another protocol or access method.
5424
5425 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5426 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5427 the request.
5428
5429 Example :
5430 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5431 # last 30 minutes
5432 backend pop
5433 mode tcp
5434 balance roundrobin
5435 stick store-request src
5436 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5437 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5438 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5439
5440 backend smtp
5441 mode tcp
5442 balance roundrobin
5443 stick match src table pop
5444 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5445 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5446
5447 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5448 extraction.
5449
5450
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005451stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005452 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5453 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005454 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005456 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005457
5458 Arguments :
5459 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5460 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5461 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5462 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5463
5464 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5465 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5466 instance.
5467
5468 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5469 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5470 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5471 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5472 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5473 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005474 to 32 characters.
5475
5476 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5477 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5478 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5479 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5480 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5481 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005482
5483 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005484 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5485 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005486 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5487 increase.
5488
5489 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005490 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5491 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5492 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005493
5494 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5495 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5496 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5497 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5498 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5499 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5500 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5501 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5502 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5503 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5504 parameter (see below).
5505
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005506 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5507 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5508 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5509 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5510 soft restart.
5511
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005512 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5513 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5514 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5515 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5516 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5517 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5518 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5519 if not expiration delay is specified.
5520
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005521 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5522 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5523 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5524 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005525 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5526 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5527 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5528 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5529 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5530 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5531 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5532 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5533 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5534 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5535 types and their arguments.
5536
5537 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5538 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5539 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5540 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5541
5542 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5543 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5544 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5545 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5546
5547 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5548 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5549 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5550 they were received.
5551
5552 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5553 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5554 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5555 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5556 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5557
5558 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5559 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5560 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5561 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5562 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5563
5564 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5565 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5566 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5567
5568 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5569 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5570 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5571 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5572 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5573
5574 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5575 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5576 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5577 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5578 the client side.
5579
5580 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5581 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5582 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5583 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5584 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5585 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5586 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5587
5588 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5589 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5590 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5591 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5592 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5593 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5594 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5595
5596 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5597 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5598 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5599 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5600 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5601 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5602
5603 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5604 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5605 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5606 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5607
5608 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5609 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5610 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5611 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5612 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5613 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5614 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5615 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5616 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5617 recommended for better fairness.
5618
5619 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5620 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5621 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5622 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5623
5624 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5625 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5626 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5627 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5628 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5629 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5630 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5631 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5632 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5633 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005634
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005635 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5636 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005637 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5638 reference it.
5639
5640 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5641 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5642 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5643 as an exclusive stickiness.
5644
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005645 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5646 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5647 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5648 something that can be ignored.
5649
5650 Example:
5651 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5652 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5653 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5654 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5655
5656 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5657 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005658
5659
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005660stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5661 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5663 no | no | yes | yes
5664
5665 Arguments :
5666 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5667 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5668 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5669 server is selected.
5670
5671 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5672 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5673 the "stick-table" statement.
5674
5675 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5676 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5677 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5678 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5679
5680 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5681 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5682 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5683 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5684 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5685 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5686 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5687 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5688 rules.
5689
5690 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5691 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5692 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5693 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5694 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5695 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5696 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5697
5698 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5699 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5700 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5701 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5702
5703 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5704 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5705 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5706 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5707 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5708 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5709 another protocol or access method.
5710
5711 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5712
5713 Example :
5714 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5715 backend https
5716 mode tcp
5717 balance roundrobin
5718 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5719 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5720
5721 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5722 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5723
5724 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5725 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5726 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5727
5728 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5729 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5730
5731 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5732 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5733 # at offset 44.
5734
5735 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5736 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5737
5738 # Learn on response if server hello.
5739 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5740
5741 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5742 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5743
5744 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5745 extraction.
5746
5747
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005748tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5749 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005752 Arguments :
5753 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5754 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5755 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005756
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005757 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005758
5759 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5760 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005761 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5762 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5763 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5764 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5765 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5766 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005768 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5769 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5770 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5771 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005772
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005773 Three types of actions are supported :
5774 - accept :
5775 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5776 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5777 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005778
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005779 - reject :
5780 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5781 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5782 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5783 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5784 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5785 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5786 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5787 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5788 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5789 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5790 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5791 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005792
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005793 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5794 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5795 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5796 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5797 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5798 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5799 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5800 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5801 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005802
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005803 These actions take one or two arguments :
5804 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5805 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5806 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005807
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005808 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5809 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5810 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5811 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005812
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005813 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5814 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5815 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5816 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5817 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5818 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5819 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5820 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5821 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5822 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005823
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005824 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5825 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5826 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005827
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005828 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5829 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5830 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005831
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005832 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005833 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005834 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005835
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005836 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5837 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5838 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005839
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005840 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5841 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5842 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005843
5844 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5845
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005846 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005847
5848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005849tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5850 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005852 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005853 Arguments :
5854 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5855 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5856 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005857
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005858 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005859
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005860 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5861 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5862 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5863 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5864 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005865
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005866 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5867 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5868 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5869 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5870 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5871 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5872 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5873 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5874 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005876 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5877 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5878 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5879 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005880
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005881 Three types of actions are supported :
5882 - accept :
5883 - reject :
5884 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005885
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005886 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5887 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005888
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005889 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5890 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5891 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5892 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5893 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5894 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005896 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005897 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5898 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005899
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005900 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5901 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5902 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5903 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5904 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005905
5906 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005907 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5908 # and reject everything else.
5909 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5910 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5911 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5912 tcp-request content reject
5913
5914 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005915 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5916 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5917 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005918 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005919
5920 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5921 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5922 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005923 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005924 tcp-request content reject
5925
5926 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5927 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5928
5929 frontend http
5930 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5931 # protecting all our sites
5932 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5933 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5934 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5935 ...
5936 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5937
5938 backend http_dynamic
5939 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5940 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5941 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5942 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5943 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5944 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5945 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005947 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005948
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005949 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005950
5951
5952tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5953 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005955 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005956 Arguments :
5957 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5958 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5959 as explained at the top of this document.
5960
5961 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5962 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5963 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5964 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5965 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5966
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005967 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5968 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5969 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5970 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5971
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005972 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
5973 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005974 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005975 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01005976 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
5977 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
5978 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
5979 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005980
5981 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
5982 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
5983 it pass through unaffected.
5984
5985 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
5986 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
5987 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005988 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005989 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
5990 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02005991 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
5992 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
5993 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005994
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005995 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005996 "timeout client".
5997
5998
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02005999tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6000 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6002 no | no | yes | yes
6003 Arguments :
6004 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6005 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6006 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6007
6008 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6009
6010 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6011 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6012 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6013 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6014 set and expires with no matching rule.
6015
6016 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6017
6018 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6019 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6020 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6021 inserted.
6022
6023 Two types of actions are supported :
6024 - accept :
6025 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6026 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6027 the rules evaluation.
6028
6029 - reject :
6030 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6031 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6032 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6033
6034 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6035 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6036 for changing the default action to a reject.
6037
6038 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6039 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6040 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6041 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6042 period.
6043
6044 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6045
6046 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6047
6048
6049tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6050 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6052 no | no | yes | yes
6053 Arguments :
6054 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6055 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6056 as explained at the top of this document.
6057
6058 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6059
6060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006061timeout check <timeout>
6062 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6063 established.
6064
6065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6066 yes | no | yes | yes
6067 Arguments:
6068 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6069 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6070 as explained at the top of this document.
6071
6072 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6073 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6074 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6075 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006076 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6077 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6078 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006079
6080 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6081 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6082
6083 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6084 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006085 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006086
6087 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6088 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6089 forget about it.
6090
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006091 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6092 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006093
6094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006095timeout client <timeout>
6096timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6097 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6099 yes | yes | yes | no
6100 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006101 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006102 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6103 as explained at the top of this document.
6104
6105 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6106 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6107 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6108 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6109 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6110 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6111 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6112 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006113 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006114 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6115 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6116
6117 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6118 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6119 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6120 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6121 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6122 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6123
6124 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6125 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6126 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6127
6128 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6129
6130
6131timeout connect <timeout>
6132timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6133 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6135 yes | no | yes | yes
6136 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006137 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006138 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6139 as explained at the top of this document.
6140
6141 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006142 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006143 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006144 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006145 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6146 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006147
6148 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6149 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6150 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6151 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6152 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6153 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6154
6155 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6156 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6157 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6158
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006159 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6160 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006161
6162
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006163timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6164 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6166 yes | yes | yes | yes
6167 Arguments :
6168 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6169 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6170 as explained at the top of this document.
6171
6172 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6173 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6174 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6175 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6176 once the request has started to present itself.
6177
6178 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6179 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6180 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6181 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6182 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6183
6184 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6185 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6186 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6187 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6188
6189 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6190 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6191 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6192 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6193 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006194 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006195
6196 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6197 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6198 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6199 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6200
6201 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6202
6203
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006204timeout http-request <timeout>
6205 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006207 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006208 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006209 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6211 as explained at the top of this document.
6212
6213 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6214 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6215 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6216 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6217 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6218 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6219 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6220 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6221
6222 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6223 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006224 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6225 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006226
6227 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6228 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6229 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6230 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6231 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6232
6233 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006234 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6235 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6236 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006237
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006238 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006239
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006240
6241timeout queue <timeout>
6242 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6244 yes | no | yes | yes
6245 Arguments :
6246 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6247 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6248 as explained at the top of this document.
6249
6250 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6251 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6252 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6253 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6254 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6255
6256 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6257 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6258 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6259 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6260
6261 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6262
6263
6264timeout server <timeout>
6265timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6266 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6268 yes | no | yes | yes
6269 Arguments :
6270 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6271 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6272 as explained at the top of this document.
6273
6274 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6275 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6276 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6277 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6278 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6279 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6280 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6281
6282 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6283 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6284 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6285 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6286 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006287 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006288 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006289 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006290
6291 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6292 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6293 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6294 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6295 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6296 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6297
6298 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6299 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6300 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6301
6302 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6303
6304
6305timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006306 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6308 yes | yes | yes | yes
6309 Arguments :
6310 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6311 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6312 as explained at the top of this document.
6313
6314 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6315 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6316 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6317
6318 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6319 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6320 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6321 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006322 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006323
6324 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6325
6326
6327transparent (deprecated)
6328 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006330 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006331 Arguments : none
6332
6333 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6334 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6335 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6336 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6337 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6338 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6339 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6340 appropriate server.
6341
6342 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6343
6344 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6345 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6346
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006347 See also: "option transparent"
6348
6349
6350use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6351use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006352 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6354 no | yes | yes | no
6355 Arguments :
6356 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006358 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006359
6360 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6361 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6362 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006363 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6364 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6365 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6366 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006367
6368 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6369 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6370 assign the backend.
6371
6372 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6373 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6374 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6375 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6376 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6377 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6378
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006379 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006380 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006381 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6382 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6383 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6384
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006385 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006386
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010063885. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006389------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006391The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6392which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6393arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6394settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6395after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6396Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6397address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006399 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006400 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006402The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006404addr <ipv4>
6405 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6406 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6407 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6408 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6409 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006411 Supported in default-server: No
6412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006413backup
6414 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6415 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6416 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6417 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6418 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6419 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006421 Supported in default-server: No
6422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006423check
6424 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6425 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6426 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6427 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6428 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6429 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6430 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6431 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6432 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006433 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
6434 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006436 Supported in default-server: No
6437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006438cookie <value>
6439 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6440 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6441 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6442 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6443 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6444 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6445 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6446
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006447 Supported in default-server: No
6448
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006449disabled
6450 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6451 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6452 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6453 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6454 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6455
6456 Supported in default-server: No
6457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006458error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006459 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6460 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6461 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006463 Supported in default-server: Yes
6464
6465 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006467fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006468 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6469 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6470 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006472 Supported in default-server: Yes
6473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006474id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006475 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6476 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6477 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006479 Supported in default-server: No
6480
6481inter <delay>
6482fastinter <delay>
6483downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006484 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6485 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6486 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6487 between checks depending on the server state :
6488
6489 Server state | Interval used
6490 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6491 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6492 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6493 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6494 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6495 or yet unchecked. |
6496 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6497 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6498 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006500 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6501 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6502 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6503 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6504 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6505 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6506 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6507 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6508 servers.
6509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006510 Supported in default-server: Yes
6511
6512maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006513 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6514 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6515 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6516 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6517 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6518 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6519 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6520 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006522 Supported in default-server: Yes
6523
6524maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006525 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6526 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6527 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6528 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6529 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6530 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6531 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006533 Supported in default-server: Yes
6534
6535minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006536 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6537 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6538 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6539 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6540 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6541 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006542 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006543 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006545 Supported in default-server: Yes
6546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006547observe <mode>
6548 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6549 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6550 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6551 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6552 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6553 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6554 headers, a timeout, etc.
6555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006556 Supported in default-server: No
6557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006558 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006560on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006561 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6562 Currently, four modes are available:
6563 - fastinter: force fastinter
6564 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6565 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6566 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6567 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006569 Supported in default-server: Yes
6570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006571 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006573port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006574 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6575 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6576 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6577 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6578 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6579 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006581 Supported in default-server: Yes
6582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006583redir <prefix>
6584 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6585 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6586 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6587 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6588 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6589 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6590 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6591 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006592 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006593 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6594 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6595 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6596 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6597 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6598
6599 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006601 Supported in default-server: No
6602
6603rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006604 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6605 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6606 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006608 Supported in default-server: Yes
6609
6610slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006611 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6612 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6613 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6614 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6615 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6616 parameters :
6617
6618 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6619 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6620
6621 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6622 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6623 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6624 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6625
6626 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6627 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6628 seen as failed.
6629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006630 Supported in default-server: Yes
6631
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006632source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006633source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006634source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006635 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6636 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6637 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6638 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6639
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006640 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6641 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6642 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6643 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6644 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6645 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6646 server.
6647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006648 Supported in default-server: No
6649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006650track [<proxy>/]<server>
6651 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6652 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6653 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6654 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6655 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006657 Supported in default-server: No
6658
6659weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006660 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6661 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6662 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006663 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6664 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6665 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6666 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6667 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6668 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006670 Supported in default-server: Yes
6671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006672
66736. HTTP header manipulation
6674---------------------------
6675
6676In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6677response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6678request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6679which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6680against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6681to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6682passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6683headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6684never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6685
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006686There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6687(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6688rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6689messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6690in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006691happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006692add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6693normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006695This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6696in section 4.2 :
6697
6698 - reqadd <string>
6699 - reqallow <search>
6700 - reqiallow <search>
6701 - reqdel <search>
6702 - reqidel <search>
6703 - reqdeny <search>
6704 - reqideny <search>
6705 - reqpass <search>
6706 - reqipass <search>
6707 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6708 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6709 - reqtarpit <search>
6710 - reqitarpit <search>
6711 - rspadd <string>
6712 - rspdel <search>
6713 - rspidel <search>
6714 - rspdeny <search>
6715 - rspideny <search>
6716 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6717 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6718
6719With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6720is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6721parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6722prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6723Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6724
6725 \t for a tab
6726 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6727 \n for a new line (LF)
6728 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6729 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6730 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6731 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6732 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6733
6734The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6735portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6736above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6737regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
67389 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6739is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6740
6741The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6742after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6743
6744Notes related to these keywords :
6745---------------------------------
6746 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6747 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6748 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6749
6750 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6751 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6752 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6753
6754 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6755 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6756 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6757 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6758 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6759
6760 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6761 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6762 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6763 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6764 useless headers before adding new ones.
6765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006766 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006767 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6768
6769 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6770 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6771 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6772
6773 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6774 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006775 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006776
6777
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010067787. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6779------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006780
6781The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6782content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6783from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6784simple :
6785
6786 - define test criteria with sets of values
6787 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6788
6789The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6790
6791In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6792
6793 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6794
6795This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6796Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6797and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6798an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6799of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6800
6801ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6802'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6803which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6804
6805There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6806performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6807
6808The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6809
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006810 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6811 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006812 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6813
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006814The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6815specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6816possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006817multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6818be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6819needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6820space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6821match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6822lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6823duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6824to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6825instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006826
6827 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6828
6829In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6830the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6831case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6832too.
6833
6834Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6835a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6836ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6837
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006838Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006839
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006840 - integers or integer ranges
6841 - strings
6842 - regular expressions
6843 - IP addresses and networks
6844
6845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068467.1. Matching integers
6847----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006848
6849Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6850that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6851expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6852may be omitted.
6853
6854For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6855unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6856representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6857
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006858As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6859two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6860instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6861ranges and operators.
6862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006863For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006864operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6865Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6866of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006868Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006869
6870 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6871 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6872 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6873 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6874 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006876For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006877
6878 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6879
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006880This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6881
6882 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6883
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068857.2. Matching strings
6886---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006887
6888String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6889exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6890characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6891string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6892to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006893before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006894
6895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068967.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6897-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006898
6899Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6900they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6901possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6902passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6903the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006904the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6905match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006906
6907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069087.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6909----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006910
6911IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6912netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6913within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006914host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006915difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6916at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6917does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6918parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006919
6920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069217.5. Available matching criteria
6922--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069247.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6925------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006926
6927A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6928analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6929addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6930
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006931always_false
6932 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6933 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6934
6935always_true
6936 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6937 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6938
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006939avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006940avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006941 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6942 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6943 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6944 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6945 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6946 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6947 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6948 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6949 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6950 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6951 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006952
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006953be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006954be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006955 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6956 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6957 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6958 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6959 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006960
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006961be_sess_rate <integer>
6962be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6963 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6964 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6965 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6966 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6967 sucking of an online dictionary).
6968
6969 Example :
6970 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
6971 backend dynamic
6972 mode http
6973 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
6974 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006975
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006976connslots <integer>
6977connslots(backend) <integer>
6978 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006979 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006980 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
6981
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006982 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
6983 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006984
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006985 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006986 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
6987 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
6988 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
6989 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
6990 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006991 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006992
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006993 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
6994 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
6995 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
6996 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006997
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006998dst <ip_address>
6999 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7000 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007002dst_conn <integer>
7003 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7004 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7005 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7006 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7007 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7008 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7009
7010dst_port <integer>
7011 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7012 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7013
7014fe_conn <integer>
7015fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
7016 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7017 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7018 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7019 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7020 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7021 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7022 criteria.
7023
7024fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007025 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007026 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007027
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007028fe_sess_rate <integer>
7029fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
7030 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7031 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7032 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7033 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7034 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7035 the rate to go down below the limit.
7036
7037 Example :
7038 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7039 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7040 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7041 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7042 frontend mail
7043 bind :25
7044 mode tcp
7045 maxconn 100
7046 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7047 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7048 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7049 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007050
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007051nbsrv <integer>
7052nbsrv(backend) <integer>
7053 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7054 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7055 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7056 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7057 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007058
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007059queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02007060queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007061 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7062 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7063 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7064 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7065 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7066 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7067 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007069sc1_bytes_in_rate
7070sc2_bytes_in_rate
7071 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7072 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7073 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7074
7075sc1_bytes_out_rate
7076sc2_bytes_out_rate
7077 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7078 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7079 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7080
7081sc1_conn_cnt
7082sc2_conn_cnt
7083 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7084 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7085
7086sc1_conn_cur
7087sc2_conn_cur
7088 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7089 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7090 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7091
7092sc1_conn_rate
7093sc2_conn_rate
7094 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7095 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7096 See also src_conn_rate.
7097
7098sc1_get_gpc0
7099sc2_get_gpc0
7100 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7101 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7102
7103sc1_http_err_cnt
7104sc2_http_err_cnt
7105 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7106 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7107 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7108
7109sc1_http_err_rate
7110sc2_http_err_rate
7111 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7112 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7113 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7114 src_http_err_rate.
7115
7116sc1_http_req_cnt
7117sc2_http_req_cnt
7118 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7119 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7120 src_http_req_cnt.
7121
7122sc1_http_req_rate
7123sc2_http_req_rate
7124 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7125 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7126 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7127 src_http_req_rate.
7128
7129sc1_inc_gpc0
7130sc2_inc_gpc0
7131 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7132 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7133 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7134 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7135 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7136 when a first ACL was verified :
7137
7138 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7139 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7140 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7141
7142sc1_kbytes_in
7143sc2_kbytes_in
7144 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7145 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7146 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7147 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7148
7149sc1_kbytes_out
7150sc2_kbytes_out
7151 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7152 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7153 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7154 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7155
7156sc1_sess_cnt
7157sc2_sess_cnt
7158 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7159 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7160 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7161 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7162 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7163 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7164
7165sc1_sess_rate
7166sc2_sess_rate
7167 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7168 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7169 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7170 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7171 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7172 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7173
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007174so_id <integer>
7175 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7176
7177src <ip_address>
7178 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7179 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7180 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7181
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007182src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
7183src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
7184 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7185 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7186 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007187 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007188
7189src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
7190src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
7191 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7192 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7193 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007194 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007195
7196src_conn_cnt <integer>
7197src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
7198 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7199 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7200 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007201 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007202
7203src_conn_cur <integer>
7204src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
7205 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7206 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7207 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007208 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007209
7210src_conn_rate <integer>
7211src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
7212 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7213 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7214 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007215 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007216
7217src_get_gpc0 <integer>
7218src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7219 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7220 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7221 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007222 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007223
7224src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7225src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7226 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7227 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7228 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007229 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007230
7231src_http_err_rate <integer>
7232src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7233 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7234 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7235 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7236 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007237 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007238
7239src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7240src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7241 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7242 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7243 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007244 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007245
7246src_http_req_rate <integer>
7247src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7248 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7249 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7250 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7251 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007252 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007253
7254src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7255src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7256 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7257 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7258 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7259 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7260 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7261 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7262
7263 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7264 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007265 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007266
7267src_kbytes_in <integer>
7268src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7269 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7270 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7271 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7272 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007273 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007274
7275src_kbytes_out <integer>
7276src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7277 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7278 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7279 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7280 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007281 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007282
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007283src_port <integer>
7284 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007285
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007286src_sess_cnt <integer>
7287src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7288 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7289 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7290 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7291 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007292 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007293
7294src_sess_rate <integer>
7295src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7296 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7297 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7298 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7299 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007300 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007301
7302src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7303src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007304 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007305 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7306 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007307 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7308 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7309 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007310 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007311
7312 Example :
7313 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7314 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7315 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7316 listen ssh
7317 bind :22
7318 mode tcp
7319 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007320 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007321 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7322 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7323
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007324srv_is_up(<server>)
7325srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7326 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7327 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7328 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7329 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7330 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7331 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7332 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7333 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7334
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007335
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020073367.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7337---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007338
7339A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7340during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007341through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7342keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007343
7344req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007345 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007346 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7347 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7348 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7349 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7350 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7351 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7352
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007353req_proto_http
7354 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7355 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007356 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007357 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7358 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7359
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007360req_rdp_cookie <string>
7361req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7362 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7363 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7364 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7365 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7366 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7367 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7368 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7369 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7370
7371req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7372req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7373 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7374 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7375 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7376 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7377 cookies.
7378
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007379req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7380 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7381 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7382 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7383 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7384 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7385 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7386 with TCP request content inspection.
7387
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007388req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7389 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7390 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7391 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7392 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7393
7394rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7395 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7396 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7397 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7398 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7399
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007400wait_end
7401 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7402 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7403 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7404 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7405 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7406 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7407 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7408 inspection.
7409
7410 Examples :
7411 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7412 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7413 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7414
7415 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7416 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7417 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7418 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7419 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7420 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7421 tcp-request content reject
7422
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074247.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7425--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007426
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007427A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007428application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7429read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7430than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7431
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007432hdr <string>
7433hdr(header) <string>
7434 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7435 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7436 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7437 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7438 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7439
7440 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7441 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7442 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7443
7444 hdr(Connection) -i close
7445
7446hdr_beg <string>
7447hdr_beg(header) <string>
7448 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7449 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7450 response headers sent by the server.
7451
7452hdr_cnt <integer>
7453hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7454 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7455 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7456 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7457 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7458 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7459 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7460 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7461
7462hdr_dir <string>
7463hdr_dir(header) <string>
7464 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7465 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7466 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7467 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7468 headers sent by the server.
7469
7470hdr_dom <string>
7471hdr_dom(header) <string>
7472 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7473 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7474 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7475 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7476 server.
7477
7478hdr_end <string>
7479hdr_end(header) <string>
7480 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7481 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7482 response headers sent by the server.
7483
7484hdr_ip <ip_address>
7485hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7486 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7487 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7488 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7489 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7490
7491hdr_reg <regex>
7492hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7493 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7494 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7495 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7496 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7497 response headers sent by the server.
7498
7499hdr_sub <string>
7500hdr_sub(header) <string>
7501 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7502 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7503 response headers sent by the server.
7504
7505hdr_val <integer>
7506hdr_val(header) <integer>
7507 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7508 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7509 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7510 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7511
7512http_auth(userlist)
7513http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7514 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7515 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7516 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7517 of specified groups.
7518
7519 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7520
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007521http_req_first
7522 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7523 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7524 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7525 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7526
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007527method <string>
7528 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7529 already check for most common methods.
7530
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007531path <string>
7532 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7533 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7534 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7535
7536path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007537 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7538 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007539
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007540path_dir <string>
7541 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7542 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7543 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7544 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7545
7546path_dom <string>
7547 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7548 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7549 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7550
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007551path_end <string>
7552 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7553 control file name extension.
7554
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007555path_reg <regex>
7556 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7557 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7558 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7559
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007560path_sub <string>
7561 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7562 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7563 "path_dir".
7564
7565req_ver <string>
7566 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7567 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7568
7569status <integer>
7570 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7571 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7572 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7573
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007574url <string>
7575 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7576 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7577
7578url_beg <string>
7579 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7580 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7581
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007582url_dir <string>
7583 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7584 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7585 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7586 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7587
7588url_dom <string>
7589 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7590 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7591 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7592
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007593url_end <string>
7594 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7595 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007596
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007597url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007598 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7599 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007600 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007601
7602url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007603 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7604 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007605 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007606 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007607
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007608url_reg <regex>
7609 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7610 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7611 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007612
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007613url_sub <string>
7614 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7615 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007616
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076187.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7619---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007621Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7622every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007623order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007625ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7626---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007627FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007628HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007629HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7630HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007631HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7632HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7633HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7634HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7635LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007636METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7637METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7638METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7639METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7640METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7641METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007642RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007643REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007644TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007645WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7646---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007647
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076497.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7650----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007652Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7653combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007655 - AND (implicit)
7656 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7657 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007659A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007661 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007663Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7664indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007666For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7667"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7668requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7669is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007671 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7672 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7673 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7674 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007676To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7677and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007679 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7680 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7681 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7682 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007684 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7685 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7686 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7687 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007688
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007689It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7690expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7691be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7692the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7693
7694 The following rule :
7695
7696 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7697 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7698
7699 Can also be written that way :
7700
7701 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7702
7703It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7704to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7705simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7706sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7707good use is the following :
7708
7709 With named ACLs :
7710
7711 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7712 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7713 monitor fail if site_dead
7714
7715 With anonymous ACLs :
7716
7717 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007719See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007720
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007721
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077227.8. Pattern extraction
7723-----------------------
7724
7725The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7726response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7727for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7728
7729All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7730"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7731begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7732arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7733much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7734equivalent used in ACLs.
7735
7736The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7737
7738 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7739 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7740
7741 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7742 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7743 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7744 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7745
7746 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7747 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7748 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7749 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7750 type integer and only works with such tables.
7751
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007752 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7753 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7754 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7755 x-forwarded-for header.
7756
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007757 payload(offset,length)
7758 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7759 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7760 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7761 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007762
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007763 payload_lv(offset1,length[,offset2])
7764 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7765 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7766 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7767 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7768 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7769 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7770 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7771 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7772
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007773The currently available list of transformations include :
7774
7775 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7776 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7777 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7778
7779 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7780 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7781 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7782
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007783 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7784 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7785 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7786 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7787 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7788
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077908. Logging
7791----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007792
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007793One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7794provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7795very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7796provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7797state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007798to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007799headers.
7800
7801In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7802about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7803send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7804
7805 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7806 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7807 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7808 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7809 at the termination.
7810
7811The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7812allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7813as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7814while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7815real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7816delay.
7817
7818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078198.1. Log levels
7820---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007821
7822TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7823source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7824HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7825in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7826particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007827syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007828facilities.
7829
7830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078318.2. Log formats
7832----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007833
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007834HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007835and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7836the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7837formats are the following ones :
7838
7839 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7840 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7841 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7842 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7843 extents.
7844
7845 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7846 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7847 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7848 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7849 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7850
7851 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7852 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7853 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7854 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7855 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7856
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007857 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7858 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7859 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7860 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7861
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007862Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7863specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7864field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7865servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7866always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7867identifier.
7868
7869Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7870 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7871 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7872 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7873 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7874
7875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078768.2.1. Default log format
7877-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007878
7879This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7880as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7881format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7882
7883 Example :
7884 listen www
7885 mode http
7886 log global
7887 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7888
7889 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7890 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7891 (www/HTTP)
7892
7893 Field Format Extract from the example above
7894 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7895 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7896 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7897 4 'to' to
7898 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7899 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7900
7901Detailed fields description :
7902 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7903 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7904 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7905 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7906 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7907 and processed the connection.
7908 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7909
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007910In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
7911"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
7912connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
7913
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007914It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7915will eventually disappear.
7916
7917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079188.2.2. TCP log format
7919---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007920
7921The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7922is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7923information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7924counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7925emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7926environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7927the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7928sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007929specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7930not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7931fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7932marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007933
7934 Example :
7935 frontend fnt
7936 mode tcp
7937 option tcplog
7938 log global
7939 default_backend bck
7940
7941 backend bck
7942 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7943
7944 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7945 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7946 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7947
7948 Field Format Extract from the example above
7949 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7950 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7951 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7952 4 frontend_name fnt
7953 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7954 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7955 7 bytes_read* 212
7956 8 termination_state --
7957 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7958 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7959
7960Detailed fields description :
7961 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007962 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
7963 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
7964 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
7965 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
7966 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007967
7968 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007969 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
7970 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
7971 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007972
7973 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
7974 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
7975 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
7976 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
7977
7978 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7979 and processed the connection.
7980
7981 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7982 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7983 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
7984 applications.
7985
7986 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7987 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7988 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7989 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
7990 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
7991
7992 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7993 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7994 See "Timers" below for more details.
7995
7996 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7997 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7998 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
7999 "Timers" below for more details.
8000
8001 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8002 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8003 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8004 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8005 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8006 details.
8007
8008 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8009 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8010 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8011 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8012 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8013
8014 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8015 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8016 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8017 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8018 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8019 for more details.
8020
8021 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8022 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8023 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8024 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8025 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008026 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008027
8028 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8029 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8030 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8031 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8032 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8033 caused by a denial of service attack.
8034
8035 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8036 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8037 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8038 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8039 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8040 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8041 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8042 denial of service attack.
8043
8044 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8045 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8046 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8047 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8048 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8049 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8050 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8051 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8052 be processed than on other servers.
8053
8054 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8055 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8056 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8057 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8058 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8059 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8060 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8061 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8062 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8063 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8064 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8065 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8066 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8067
8068 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8069 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8070 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8071 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8072 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8073 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8074 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8075 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8076
8077 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8078 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8079 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8080 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8081 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8082 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8083 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8084 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8085 occurs.
8086
8087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080888.2.3. HTTP log format
8089----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008090
8091The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8092is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8093the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8094are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8095emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8096generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8097"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8098which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008099frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8100is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008101
8102Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8103slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8104with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8105
8106 Example :
8107 frontend http-in
8108 mode http
8109 option httplog
8110 log global
8111 default_backend bck
8112
8113 backend static
8114 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8115
8116 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8117 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8118 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008119 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008120
8121 Field Format Extract from the example above
8122 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8123 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8124 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8125 4 frontend_name http-in
8126 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8127 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8128 7 status_code 200
8129 8 bytes_read* 2750
8130 9 captured_request_cookie -
8131 10 captured_response_cookie -
8132 11 termination_state ----
8133 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8134 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8135 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8136 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8137 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008138
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008139
8140Detailed fields description :
8141 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008142 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8143 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8144 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8145 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8146 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008147
8148 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008149 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8150 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8151 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008152
8153 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8154 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8155 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8156 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8157 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8158
8159 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8160 and processed the connection.
8161
8162 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8163 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8164 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8165
8166 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8167 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8168 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8169 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8170 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8171 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8172
8173 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8174 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8175 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8176 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8177 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8178 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8179
8180 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8181 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8182 See "Timers" below for more details.
8183
8184 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8185 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8186 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8187 below for more details.
8188
8189 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8190 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8191 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8192 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8193 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8194 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8195 for more details.
8196
8197 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8198 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8199 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8200 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8201 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8202 details.
8203
8204 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8205 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8206 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8207
8208 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8209 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8210 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8211 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8212 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8213 overflowing.
8214
8215 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8216 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8217 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8218 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8219 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8220 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8221 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8222 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8223
8224 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8225 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8226 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8227 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8228 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8229 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8230 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8231 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8232
8233 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8234 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8235 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8236 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8237 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8238 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8239 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8240
8241 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8242 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8243 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8244 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8245 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008246 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008247 system.
8248
8249 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8250 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8251 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8252 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8253 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8254 caused by a denial of service attack.
8255
8256 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8257 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8258 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8259 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8260 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8261 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8262 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8263 denial of service attack.
8264
8265 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8266 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8267 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8268 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8269 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8270 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8271 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8272 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8273 processed than on other servers.
8274
8275 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8276 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8277 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8278 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8279 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8280 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8281 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8282 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8283 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8284 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8285 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8286 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8287 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8288
8289 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8290 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8291 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8292 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8293 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8294 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8295 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8296 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8297
8298 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8299 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8300 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8301 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8302 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8303 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8304 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8305 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8306 occurs.
8307
8308 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8309 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8310 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8311 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8312 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8313 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8314 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8315 cookies" below for more details.
8316
8317 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8318 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8319 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8320 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8321 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8322 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8323 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8324 and cookies" below for more details.
8325
8326 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8327 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8328 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8329 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8330 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8331 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8332 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8333 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8334
8335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083368.3. Advanced logging options
8337-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008338
8339Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8340just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8341options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8342for more information about their usage.
8343
8344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083458.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8346------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008347
8348It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8349haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8350commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8351monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8352ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8353
8354 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8355 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8356 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8357 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8358
8359 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8360 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8361 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8362 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8363 such as other load-balancers.
8364
8365 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8366 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8367 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8368
8369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083708.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8371----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008372
8373The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8374what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8375or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8376"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8377just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8378log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8379after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8380is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8381with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8382with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8383
8384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8386------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008387
8388Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8389for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8390"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8391retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8392raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8393a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8394file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8395you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8396"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8397
8398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8400--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008401
8402Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8403multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8404them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8405"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8406logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8407error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8408and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8409too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8410useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8411alternative.
8412
8413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084148.4. Timing events
8415------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008416
8417Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8418reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8419the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8420frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8421mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8422
8423 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8424 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8425 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8426 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8427 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8428
8429 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8430 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8431 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8432 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8433 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8434
8435 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8436 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8437 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8438 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8439 connection never established.
8440
8441 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8442 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8443 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8444 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8445 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8446 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8447 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8448 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8449 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8450 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8451 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8452
8453 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8454 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8455 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8456 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8457 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8458
8459 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8460
8461 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8462 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8463 negative.
8464
8465These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8466protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8467that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008468due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008469close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8470session has been aborted on timeout.
8471
8472Most common cases :
8473
8474 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8475 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8476 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8477 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8478 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8479 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8480 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8481 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8482 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008483 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8484 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8485 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008486
8487 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8488 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8489 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8490 of ms on remote networks.
8491
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008492 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8493 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8494 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008495
8496 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8497 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8498 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8499 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8500 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8501 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8502 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8503 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8504 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8505 to the server until another one is released.
8506
8507Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8508
8509 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8510 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8511 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8512
8513 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8514 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8515 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8516
8517 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8518 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8519 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8520 flags.
8521
8522 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8523 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8524 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8525 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8526 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8527 the client connection was maintained open.
8528
8529 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8530 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8531 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8532 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8533
8534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085358.5. Session state at disconnection
8536-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008537
8538TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8539"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
85402-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8541each of which has a special meaning :
8542
8543 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8544 session to terminate :
8545
8546 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8547
8548 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8549 server explicitly refused it.
8550
8551 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8552 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8553 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8554 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8555 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8556 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8557
8558 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8559 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8560 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8561 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8562 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8563
8564 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8565 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8566 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8567 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8568 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8569
8570 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8571 send or receive data.
8572
8573 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8574 send or receive data.
8575
8576 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8577 with nothing left in the buffers.
8578
8579 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8580
8581 R : th proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
8582 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8583
8584 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8585 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8586 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8587 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8588 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8589
8590 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8591 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8592
8593 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8594 server (HTTP only).
8595
8596 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8597
8598 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8599 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8600 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8601
8602 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8603 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8604 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8605
8606 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8607
8608 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8609 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8610
8611 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8612 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8613 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8614
8615 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8616 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008617 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8618 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008619
8620 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8621 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8622 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8623 another server.
8624
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008625 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008626 server.
8627
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008628 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8629 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8630 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8631 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8632
8633 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8634 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8635 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8636 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8637
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008638 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8639
8640 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8641 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8642
8643 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8644
8645 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8646 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8647 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8648
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008649 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8650 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8651 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8652 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8653 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8654
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008655 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8656
8657 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8658 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8659
8660 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8661
8662 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8663
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008664The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8665was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008666helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8667starvation, attacks, etc...
8668
8669The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8670alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8671easier finding and understanding.
8672
8673 Flags Reason
8674
8675 -- Normal termination.
8676
8677 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8678 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8679 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8680 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8681
8682 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8683 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8684 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8685 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8686 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8687 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008688
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008689 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8690 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8691 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8692
8693 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8694 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8695 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8696
8697 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8698 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8699 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8700 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8701 the server takes too long to respond.
8702
8703 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8704 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8705 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8706 long a time to respond.
8707
8708 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8709 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8710 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8711 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8712 and the client.
8713
8714 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8715 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8716 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8717 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8718 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8719 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8720
8721 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8722 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008723 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8724 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8725 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8726 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008728 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008729 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8730 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8731 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8732 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8733 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8734
8735 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8736 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8737 503 or 504 here.
8738
8739 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8740 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8741 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8742 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8743 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8744
8745 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8746 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008747 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008748 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8749 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8750
8751 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8752 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8753 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8754 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8755 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8756 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8757 between haproxy and the server.
8758
8759 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8760 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8761 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8762 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8763 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8764 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8765 solution is to fix the application.
8766
8767 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8768 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8769 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8770 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8771 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8772 external attacks.
8773
8774 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8775 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8776 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8777 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8778 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8779
8780 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8781 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8782 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8783 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
8784 containing unauthorized characters.
8785
8786 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8787 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8788 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8789 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8790
8791 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8792 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8793 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8794 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8795
8796 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8797 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8798 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8799 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8800
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008801The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8802persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8803important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8804re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8805
8806 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8807
8808 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8809 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8810 set on a GET request.
8811
8812 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8813 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8814 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8815 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8816
8817 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8818 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8819 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8820
8821 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8822 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8823 already got a cookie.
8824
8825 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8826 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8827 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8828 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8829 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8830
8831 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8832 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8833 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8834
8835 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8836 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8837 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8838
8839 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8840 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8841
8842 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8843 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8844 then advertised in the response.
8845
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088478.6. Non-printable characters
8848-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008849
8850In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8851consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8852converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8853prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8854being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8855escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8856is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8857'}' when logging headers.
8858
8859Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8860issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8861containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8862
8863Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8864the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8865performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8866
8867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088688.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8869---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008870
8871Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8872achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008873section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008874cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8875the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8876the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008877locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008878not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8879user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8880a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8881wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8882
8883 Examples :
8884 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8885 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8886
8887 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8888 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8889
8890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8892---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008893
8894Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8895proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8896the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8897server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8898
8899Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8900response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008901section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008902
8903It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008904time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8905appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008906are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8907and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8908follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8909request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8910in the logs.
8911
8912 Example :
8913 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8914 listen proxy-out
8915 mode http
8916 option httplog
8917 option logasap
8918 log global
8919 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8920
8921 # log the name of the virtual server
8922 capture request header Host len 20
8923
8924 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8925 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8926
8927 # log the beginning of the referrer
8928 capture request header Referer len 20
8929
8930 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8931 capture response header Server len 20
8932
8933 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8934 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8935
8936 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8937 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8938
8939 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8940 capture response header Via len 20
8941
8942 # log the URL location during a redirection
8943 capture response header Location len 20
8944
8945 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8946 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8947 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8948 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8949 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
8950
8951 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8952 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8953 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8954 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008955 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008956
8957 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8958 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8959 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8960 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
8961 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008962 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008963
8964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089658.9. Examples of logs
8966---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008967
8968These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
8969them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
8970reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
8971
8972 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
8973 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8974 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8975
8976 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
8977 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
8978
8979 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
8980 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
8981 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8982
8983 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
8984 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
8985
8986 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
8987 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8988 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8989
8990 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008991 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008992 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
8993 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
8994
8995 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
8996 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
8997 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
8998
8999 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9000 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9001 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9002 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9003 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9004 to return the 502 and not the server.
9005
9006 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009007 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009008
9009 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9010 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9011 Nothing was sent to any server.
9012
9013 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9014 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9015
9016 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9017 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9018 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9019 send a 408 return code to the client.
9020
9021 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9022 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9023
9024 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9025 5 seconds ("c----").
9026
9027 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9028 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009029 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009030
9031 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009032 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009033 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9034 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9035 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9036 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9037 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009038
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090409. Statistics and monitoring
9041----------------------------
9042
9043It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9044mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9045CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9046Unix socket.
9047
9048
90499.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009050---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009051
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009052The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9053page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009055 0. pxname: proxy name
9056 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9057 for server)
9058 2. qcur: current queued requests
9059 3. qmax: max queued requests
9060 4. scur: current sessions
9061 5. smax: max sessions
9062 6. slim: sessions limit
9063 7. stot: total sessions
9064 8. bin: bytes in
9065 9. bout: bytes out
9066 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009067 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009068 12. ereq: request errors
9069 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009070 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009071 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9072 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009073 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009074 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9075 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9076 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9077 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9078 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9079 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9080 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9081 25. qlimit: queue limit
9082 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9083 27. iid: unique proxy id
9084 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9085 29. throttle: warm up status
9086 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9087 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009088 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009089 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9090 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9091 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009092 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009093 UNK -> unknown
9094 INI -> initializing
9095 SOCKERR -> socket error
9096 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9097 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9098 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9099 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9100 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9101 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9102 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9103 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9104 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9105 disable-on-404
9106 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9107 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9108 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009109 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9110 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009111 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9112 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9113 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9114 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9115 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9116 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009117 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9118 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9119 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9120 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009121 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9122 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009123
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091259.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009126-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009127
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009128The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009129must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9130is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9131a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9132risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9133followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9134given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9135then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9136to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009137
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009138It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9139on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9140own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009141
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009142clear counters
9143 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9144 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9145 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9146 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9147 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9148
9149clear counters all
9150 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9151 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9152 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9153
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009154clear table <table> key <key>
9155 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
9156 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
9157 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
9158 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
9159 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
9160 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
9161 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
9162 usuall enough.
9163
9164 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009165 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009166 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009167 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9168 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9169 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9170 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009171
9172 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9173
9174 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009175 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009176 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9177 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009178
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009179disable server <backend>/<server>
9180 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9181 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9182 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9183 during the maintenance.
9184
9185 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9186 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9187
9188 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9189 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9190
9191 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9192 level "admin".
9193
9194enable server <backend>/<server>
9195 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9196 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9197
9198 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9199 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9200
9201 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9202 level "admin".
9203
9204get weight <backend>/<server>
9205 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9206 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9207 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9208 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9209 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
9210 dash ('#').
9211
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009212help
9213 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9214 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009215
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009216prompt
9217 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9218 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9219 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9220 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9221 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9222 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9223 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9224 command.
9225
9226quit
9227 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009228
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009229set timeout cli <delay>
9230 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9231 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9232 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9233
9234set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9235 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9236 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9237 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9238 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9239 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9240 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9241 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9242 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9243 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9244 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9245 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9246 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9247 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9248 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9249
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009250show errors [<iid>]
9251 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9252 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009253 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9254 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9255 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009256
9257 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9258 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9259 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9260 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9261 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9262 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9263 are reported too.
9264
9265 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9266 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9267 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9268 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9269 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9270 code.
9271
9272 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9273 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9274 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9275 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9276 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9277 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9278 line.
9279
9280 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009281 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9282 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009283 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9284 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9285
9286 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9287 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9288 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9289 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9290 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9291 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9292 00204+ minal\r\n
9293 00211 \r\n
9294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009295 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009296 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9297 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9298 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9299 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9300 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9301 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009302
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009303show info
9304 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9305
9306show sess
9307 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009308 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9309 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9310
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009311show sess <id>
9312 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9313 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9314 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9315 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9316 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9317 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009318
9319show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9320 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9321 possible to dump only selected items :
9322 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9323 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9324 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9325 for example:
9326 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9327 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9328 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9329
9330 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009331 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9332 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009333 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9334 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9335 Nbproc: 1
9336 Process_num: 1
9337 (...)
9338
9339 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9340 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9341 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9342 (...)
9343 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9344
9345 $
9346
9347 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9348 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9349 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9350 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009351 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009352
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009353show table
9354 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9355 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9356 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9357 entries currently in use.
9358
9359 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009360 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9361 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9362 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009363
9364show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
9365 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9366 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9367 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
9368 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
9369 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
9370 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
9371 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
9372 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9373 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9374 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9375 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9376 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9377 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9378 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9379
9380 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009381 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9382 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9383 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9384 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9385 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9386 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009387
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009388 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9389 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9390 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9391 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009392
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009393 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9394 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9395 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9396 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9397 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009398
9399 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9400 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9401 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9402 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9403 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9404
9405 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9406 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9407 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009408 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9409 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009410 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9411 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009412
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009413/*
9414 * Local variables:
9415 * fill-column: 79
9416 * End:
9417 */